Project Gutenberg's The Earliest Arithmetics in English, by Anonymous This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org Title: The Earliest Arithmetics in English Author: Anonymous Editor: Robert Steele Release Date: June 1, 2008 [EBook #25664] Language: English Character set encoding: ISO-8859-1 *** START OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK THE EARLIEST ARITHMETICS IN ENGLISH *** Produced by Louise Hope, David Starner and the Online Distributed Proofreading Team at http://www.pgdp.net [Transcriber's Note: This text is intended for users whose text readers cannot use the "real" (unicode/utf-8) version of the file. Characters that could not be fully displayed have been "unpacked" and shown in brackets: [gh] (yogh) [n~], [l~l] (n with curl, crossed l: see below) +0+ (Greek phi: see below) In _The Crafte of Nombrynge_, final "n" was sometimes written with an extra curl. In this Latin-1 text it is shown as [n~]. In the same selection, the numeral "0" was sometimes printed as the Greek letter phi. It is shown here as +0+ rather than the usual +ph+ because the physical form is more significant than the sound of the letter. Double "l" with a line is shown as [l~l]. The first few occurrences of "d" (for "pence") were printed with a decorative curl. The letter is shown with the same "d“" used in the remainder of the text. The word "withdraw" or "w{i}t{h}draw" was inconsistently hyphenated; it was left as printed, and line-end hyphens were retained. Superscripts are shown with carets as ^e. Except for [Illustration] markers and similar, and the letters noted above, all brackets are in the original. Individual letters were italicized to show expanded abbreviations; these are shown in br{ac}es. Other italicized words are shown conventionally with _lines_, boldface with +marks+. When a footnote called for added text, the addition is shown in the body text with [[double brackets]]. The original text contained at least five types of marginal note. Details are given at the end of the e-text, followed by a listing of typographical errors.] * * * * * * * * * * * * * * The Earliest Arithmetics in English Early English Text Society. Extra Series, No. CXVIII. 1922 (for 1916). THE EARLIEST ARITHMETICS IN ENGLISH Edited With Introduction by ROBERT STEELE London: Published for the Early English Text Society By Humphrey Milford, Oxford University Press, Amen Corner, E.C. 4. 1922. [Titles (list added by transcriber): The Crafte of Nombrynge The Art of Nombryng Accomptynge by Counters The arte of nombrynge by the hande APP. I. A Treatise on the Numeration of Algorism APP. II. Carmen de Algorismo] INTRODUCTION The number of English arithmetics before the sixteenth century is very small. This is hardly to be wondered at, as no one requiring to use even the simplest operations of the art up to the middle of the fifteenth century was likely to be ignorant of Latin, in which language there were several treatises in a considerable number of manuscripts, as shown by the quantity of them still in existence. Until modern commerce was fairly well established, few persons required more arithmetic than addition and subtraction, and even in the thirteenth century, scientific treatises addressed to advanced students contemplated the likelihood of their not being able to do simple division. On the other hand, the study of astronomy necessitated, from its earliest days as a science, considerable skill and accuracy in computation, not only in the calculation of astronomical tables but in their use, a knowledge of which latter was fairly common from the thirteenth to the sixteenth centuries. The arithmetics in English known to me are:-- (1) Bodl. 790 G. VII. (2653) f. 146-154 (15th c.) _inc._ "Of angrym ther be IX figures in numbray . . ." A mere unfinished fragment, only getting as far as Duplation. (2) Camb. Univ. LI. IV. 14 (III.) f. 121-142 (15th c.) _inc._ "Al maner of thyngis that prosedeth ffro the frist begynnyng . . ." (3) Fragmentary passages or diagrams in Sloane 213 f. 120-3 (a fourteenth-century counting board), Egerton 2852 f. 5-13, Harl. 218 f. 147 and (4) The two MSS. here printed; Eg. 2622 f. 136 and Ashmole 396 f. 48. All of these, as the language shows, are of the fifteenth century. The CRAFTE OF NOMBRYNGE is one of a large number of scientific treatises, mostly in Latin, bound up together as Egerton MS. 2622 in the British Museum Library. It measures 7" × 5", 29-30 lines to the page, in a rough hand. The English is N.E. Midland in dialect. It is a translation and amplification of one of the numerous glosses on the _de algorismo_ of Alexander de Villa Dei (c. 1220), such as that of Thomas of Newmarket contained in the British Museum MS. Reg. 12, E. 1. A fragment of another translation of the same gloss was printed by Halliwell in his _Rara Mathematica_ (1835) p. 29.[1*] It corresponds, as far as p. 71, l. 2, roughly to p. 3 of our version, and from thence to the end p. 2, ll. 16-40. [Footnote 1*: Halliwell printed the two sides of his leaf in the wrong order. This and some obvious errors of transcription-- 'ferye' for 'ferthe,' 'lest' for 'left,' etc., have not been corrected in the reprint on pp. 70-71.] The ART OF NOMBRYNG is one of the treatises bound up in the Bodleian MS. Ashmole 396. It measures 11½" × 17¾", and is written with thirty-three lines to the page in a fifteenth century hand. It is a translation, rather literal, with amplifications of the _de arte numerandi_ attributed to John of Holywood (Sacrobosco) and the translator had obviously a poor MS. before him. The _de arte numerandi_ was printed in 1488, 1490 (_s.n._), 1501, 1503, 1510, 1517, 1521, 1522, 1523, 1582, and by Halliwell separately and in his two editions of _Rara Mathematica_, 1839 and 1841, and reprinted by Curze in 1897. Both these tracts are here printed for the first time, but the first having been circulated in proof a number of years ago, in an endeavour to discover other manuscripts or parts of manuscripts of it, Dr. David Eugene Smith, misunderstanding the position, printed some pages in a curious transcript with four facsimiles in the _Archiv für die Geschichte der Naturwissenschaften und der Technik_, 1909, and invited the scientific world to take up the "not unpleasant task" of editing it. ACCOMPTYNGE BY COUNTERS is reprinted from the 1543 edition of Robert Record's Arithmetic, printed by R. Wolfe. It has been reprinted within the last few years by Mr. F. P. Barnard, in his work on Casting Counters. It is the earliest English treatise we have on this variety of the Abacus (there are Latin ones of the end of the fifteenth century), but there is little doubt in my mind that this method of performing the simple operations of arithmetic is much older than any of the pen methods. At the end of the treatise there follows a note on merchants' and auditors' ways of setting down sums, and lastly, a system of digital numeration which seems of great antiquity and almost world-wide extension. After the fragment already referred to, I print as an appendix the 'Carmen de Algorismo' of Alexander de Villa Dei in an enlarged and corrected form. It was printed for the first time by Halliwell in _Rara Mathemathica_, but I have added a number of stanzas from various manuscripts, selecting various readings on the principle that the verses were made to scan, aided by the advice of my friend Mr. Vernon Rendall, who is not responsible for the few doubtful lines I have conserved. This poem is at the base of all other treatises on the subject in medieval times, but I am unable to indicate its sources. THE SUBJECT MATTER. Ancient and medieval writers observed a distinction between the Science and the Art of Arithmetic. The classical treatises on the subject, those of Euclid among the Greeks and Boethius among the Latins, are devoted to the Science of Arithmetic, but it is obvious that coeval with practical Astronomy the Art of Calculation must have existed and have made considerable progress. If early treatises on this art existed at all they must, almost of necessity, have been in Greek, which was the language of science for the Romans as long as Latin civilisation existed. But in their absence it is safe to say that no involved operations were or could have been carried out by means of the alphabetic notation of the Greeks and Romans. Specimen sums have indeed been constructed by moderns which show its possibility, but it is absurd to think that men of science, acquainted with Egyptian methods and in possession of the abacus,[2*] were unable to devise methods for its use. [Footnote 2*: For Egyptian use see Herodotus, ii. 36, Plato, _de Legibus_, VII.] THE PRE-MEDIEVAL INSTRUMENTS USED IN CALCULATION. The following are known:-- (1) A flat polished surface or tablets, strewn with sand, on which figures were inscribed with a stylus. (2) A polished tablet divided longitudinally into nine columns (or more) grouped in threes, with which counters were used, either plain or marked with signs denoting the nine numerals, etc. (3) Tablets or boxes containing nine grooves or wires, in or on which ran beads. (4) Tablets on which nine (or more) horizontal lines were marked, each third being marked off. The only Greek counting board we have is of the fourth class and was discovered at Salamis. It was engraved on a block of marble, and measures 5 feet by 2½. Its chief part consists of eleven parallel lines, the 3rd, 6th, and 9th being marked with a cross. Another section consists of five parallel lines, and there are three rows of arithmetical symbols. This board could only have been used with counters (_calculi_), preferably unmarked, as in our treatise of _Accomptynge by Counters_. CLASSICAL ROMAN METHODS OF CALCULATION. We have proof of two methods of calculation in ancient Rome, one by the first method, in which the surface of sand was divided into columns by a stylus or the hand. Counters (_calculi_, or _lapilli_), which were kept in boxes (_loculi_), were used in calculation, as we learn from Horace's schoolboys (Sat. 1. vi. 74). For the sand see Persius I. 131, "Nec qui abaco numeros et secto in pulvere metas scit risisse," Apul. Apolog. 16 (pulvisculo), Mart. Capella, lib. vii. 3, 4, etc. Cicero says of an expert calculator "eruditum attigisse pulverem," (de nat. Deorum, ii. 18). Tertullian calls a teacher of arithmetic "primus numerorum arenarius" (de Pallio, _in fine_). The counters were made of various materials, ivory principally, "Adeo nulla uncia nobis est eboris, etc." (Juv. XI. 131), sometimes of precious metals, "Pro calculis albis et nigris aureos argenteosque habebat denarios" (Pet. Arb. Satyricon, 33). There are, however, still in existence four Roman counting boards of a kind which does not appear to come into literature. A typical one is of the third class. It consists of a number of transverse wires, broken at the middle. On the left hand portion four beads are strung, on the right one (or two). The left hand beads signify units, the right hand one five units. Thus any number up to nine can be represented. This instrument is in all essentials the same as the Swanpan or Abacus in use throughout the Far East. The Russian stchota in use throughout Eastern Europe is simpler still. The method of using this system is exactly the same as that of _Accomptynge by Counters_, the right-hand five bead replacing the counter between the lines. THE BOETHIAN ABACUS. Between classical times and the tenth century we have little or no guidance as to the art of calculation. Boethius (fifth century), at the end of lib. II. of his _Geometria_ gives us a figure of an abacus of the second class with a set of counters arranged within it. It has, however, been contended with great probability that the whole passage is a tenth century interpolation. As no rules are given for its use, the chief value of the figure is that it gives the signs of the nine numbers, known as the Boethian "apices" or "notae" (from whence our word "notation"). To these we shall return later on. THE ABACISTS. It would seem probable that writers on the calendar like Bede (A.D. 721) and Helpericus (A.D. 903) were able to perform simple calculations; though we are unable to guess their methods, and for the most part they were dependent on tables taken from Greek sources. We have no early medieval treatises on arithmetic, till towards the end of the tenth century we find a revival of the study of science, centring for us round the name of Gerbert, who became Pope as Sylvester II. in 999. His treatise on the use of the Abacus was written (c. 980) to a friend Constantine, and was first printed among the works of Bede in the Basle (1563) edition of his works, I. 159, in a somewhat enlarged form. Another tenth century treatise is that of Abbo of Fleury (c. 988), preserved in several manuscripts. Very few treatises on the use of the Abacus can be certainly ascribed to the eleventh century, but from the beginning of the twelfth century their numbers increase rapidly, to judge by those that have been preserved. The Abacists used a permanent board usually divided into twelve columns; the columns were grouped in threes, each column being called an "arcus," and the value of a figure in it represented a tenth of what it would have in the column to the left, as in our arithmetic of position. With this board counters or jetons were used, either plain or, more probably, marked with numerical signs, which with the early Abacists were the "apices," though counters from classical times were sometimes marked on one side with the digital signs, on the other with Roman numerals. Two ivory discs of this kind from the Hamilton collection may be seen at the British Museum. Gerbert is said by Richer to have made for the purpose of computation a thousand counters of horn; the usual number of a set of counters in the sixteenth and seventeenth centuries was a hundred. Treatises on the Abacus usually consist of chapters on Numeration explaining the notation, and on the rules for Multiplication and Division. Addition, as far as it required any rules, came naturally under Multiplication, while Subtraction was involved in the process of Division. These rules were all that were needed in Western Europe in centuries when commerce hardly existed, and astronomy was unpractised, and even they were only required in the preparation of the calendar and the assignments of the royal exchequer. In England, for example, when the hide developed from the normal holding of a household into the unit of taxation, the calculation of the geldage in each shire required a sum in division; as we know from the fact that one of the Abacists proposes the sum: "If 200 marks are levied on the county of Essex, which contains according to Hugh of Bocland 2500 hides, how much does each hide pay?"[3*] Exchequer methods up to the sixteenth century were founded on the abacus, though when we have details later on, a different and simpler form was used. [Footnote 3*: See on this Dr. Poole, _The Exchequer in the Twelfth Century_, Chap. III., and Haskins, _Eng. Hist. Review_, 27, 101. The hidage of Essex in 1130 was 2364 hides.] The great difficulty of the early Abacists, owing to the absence of a figure representing zero, was to place their results and operations in the proper columns of the abacus, especially when doing a division sum. The chief differences noticeable in their works are in the methods for this rule. Division was either done directly or by means of differences between the divisor and the next higher multiple of ten to the divisor. Later Abacists made a distinction between "iron" and "golden" methods of division. The following are examples taken from a twelfth century treatise. In following the operations it must be remembered that a figure asterisked represents a counter taken from the board. A zero is obviously not needed, and the result may be written down in words. (_a_) MULTIPLICATION. 4600 × 23. +-----------+-----------+ | Thousands | | +---+---+---+---+---+---+ | H | T | U | H | T | U | | u | e | n | u | e | n | | n | n | i | n | n | i | | d | s | t | d | s | t | | r | | s | r | | s | | e | | | e | | | | d | | | d | | | | s | | | s | | | +---+---+---+---+---+---+ | | | 4 | 6 | | | +Multiplicand.+ +---+---+---+---+---+---+ | | | 1 | 8 | | | 600 × 3. | | 1 | 2 | | | | 4000 × 3. | | 1 | 2 | | | | 600 × 20. | | 8 | | | | | 4000 × 20. +---+---+---+---+---+---+ | 1 | | 5 | 8 | | | Total product. +---+---+---+---+---+---+ | | | | | 2 | 3 | +Multiplier.+ +---+---+---+---+---+---+ (_b_) DIVISION: DIRECT. 100,000 ÷ 20,023. Here each counter in turn is a separate divisor. +-----------+-----------+ | Thousands | | +---+---+---+---+---+---+ | H.| T.| U.| H.| T.| U.| +---+---+---+---+---+---+ | | 2 | | | 2 | 3 | +Divisors.+ +---+---+---+---+---+---+ | | 2 | | | | | Place greatest divisor to right of dividend. | 1 | | | | | | +Dividend.+ | | 2 | | | | | Remainder. | | | | 1 | | | | | 1 | 9 | 9 | | | Another form of same. | | | | | 8 | | Product of 1st Quotient and 20. +---+---+---+---+---+---+ | | 1 | 9 | 9 | 2 | | Remainder. | | | | | 1 | 2 | Product of 1st Quotient and 3. +---+---+---+---+---+---+ | | 1 | 9 | 9 | | 8 | +Final remainder.+ | | | | | | 4 | Quotient. +---+---+---+---+---+---+ (_c_) DIVISION BY DIFFERENCES. 900 ÷ 8. Here we divide by (10-2). +---+---+---+-----+---+---+ | | | | H. | T.| U.| +---+---+---+-----+---+---+ | | | | | | 2 | Difference. | | | | | | 8 | Divisor. +---+---+---+-----+---+---+ | | | |[4*]9| | | +Dividend.+ | | | |[4*]1| 8 | | Product of difference by 1st Quotient (9). | | | | | 2 | | Product of difference by 2nd Quotient (1). +---+---+---+-----+---+---+ | | | |[4*]1| | | Sum of 8 and 2. | | | | | 2 | | Product of difference by 3rd Quotient (1). | | | | | | 4 | Product of difference by 4th Quot. (2). | | | | | | | +Remainder.+ +---+---+---+-----+---+---+ | | | | | | 2 | 4th Quotient. | | | | | 1 | | 3rd Quotient. | | | | | 1 | | 2nd Quotient. | | | | | 9 | | 1st Quotient. +---+---+---+-----+---+---+ | | | | 1 | 1 | 2 | +Quotient.+ (+Total of all four.+) +---+---+---+-----+---+---+ [Footnote 4*: These figures are removed at the next step.] DIVISION. 7800 ÷ 166. +---------------+---------------+ | Thousands | | +----+----+-----+-----+----+----+ | H. | T. | U. | H. | T. | U. | +----+----+-----+-----+----+----+ | | | | | 3 | 4 | Differences (making 200 trial | | | | | | | divisor). | | | | 1 | 6 | 6 | Divisors. +----+----+-----+-----+----+----+ | | |[4*]7| 8 | | | +Dividends.+ | | | 1 | | | | Remainder of greatest dividend. | | | | 1 | 2 | | Product of 1st difference (4) | | | | | | | by 1st Quotient (3). | | | | 9 | | | Product of 2nd difference (3) | | | | | | | by 1st Quotient (3). +----+----+-----+-----+----+----+ | | |[4*]2| 8 | 2 | | New dividends. | | | | 3 | 4 | | Product of 1st and 2nd difference | | | | | | | by 2nd Quotient (1). +----+----+-----+-----+----+----+ | | |[4*]1| 1 | 6 | | New dividends. | | | | | 2 | | Product of 1st difference by | | | | | | | 3rd Quotient (5). | | | | 1 | 5 | | Product of 2nd difference by | | | | | | | 3rd Quotient (5). +----+----+-----+-----+----+----+ | | | |[4*]3| 3 | | New dividends. | | | | 1 | | | Remainder of greatest dividend. | | | | | 3 | 4 | Product of 1st and 2nd difference | | | | | | | by 4th Quotient (1). +----+----+-----+-----+----+----+ | | | | 1 | 6 | 4 | +Remainder+ (less than divisor). | | | | | | 1 | 4th Quotient. | | | | | | 5 | 3rd Quotient. | | | | | 1 | | 2nd Quotient. | | | | | 3 | | 1st Quotient. +----+----+-----+-----+----+----+ | | | | | 4 | 6 | +Quotient.+ +----+----+-----+-----+----+----+ [Footnote 4*: These figures are removed at the next step.] DIVISION. 8000 ÷ 606. +-------------+-----------+ | Thousands | | +---+---+-----+---+---+---+ | H.| T.| U. | H.| T.| U.| +---+---+-----+---+---+---+ | | | | | 9 | | Difference (making 700 trial divisor). | | | | | | 4 | Difference. | | | | 6 | | 6 | Divisors. +---+---+-----+---+---+---+ | | |[4*]8| | | | +Dividend.+ | | | 1 | | | | Remainder of dividend. | | | | 9 | 4 | | Product of difference 1 and 2 with | | | | | | | 1st Quotient (1). +---+---+-----+---+---+---+ | | |[4*]1| 9 | 4 | | New dividends. | | | | 3 | | | Remainder of greatest dividend. | | | | | 9 | 4 | Product of difference 1 and 2 with 2nd | | | | | | | Quotient (1). +---+---+-----+---+---+---+ | | |[4*]1| 3 | 3 | 4 | New dividends. | | | | 3 | | | Remainder of greatest dividend. | | | | | 9 | 4 | Product of difference 1 and 2 with 3rd | | | | | | | Quotient (1). +---+---+-----+---+---+---+ | | | | 7 | 2 | 8 | New dividends. | | | | 6 | | 6 | Product of divisors by 4th Quotient (1). +---+---+-----+---+---+---+ | | | | 1 | 2 | 2 | +Remainder.+ | | | | | | 1 | 4th Quotient. | | | | | | 1 | 3rd Quotient. | | | | | | 1 | 2nd Quotient. | | | | | 1 | | 1st Quotient. +---+---+-----+---+---+---+ | | | | | 1 | 3 | +Quotient.+ +---+---+-----+---+---+---+ [Footnote 4*: These figures are removed at the next step.] The chief Abacists are Gerbert (tenth century), Abbo, and Hermannus Contractus (1054), who are credited with the revival of the art, Bernelinus, Gerland, and Radulphus of Laon (twelfth century). We know as English Abacists, Robert, bishop of Hereford, 1095, "abacum et lunarem compotum et celestium cursum astrorum rimatus," Turchillus Compotista (Thurkil), and through him of Guilielmus R. . . . "the best of living computers," Gislebert, and Simonus de Rotellis (Simon of the Rolls). They flourished most probably in the first quarter of the twelfth century, as Thurkil's treatise deals also with fractions. Walcher of Durham, Thomas of York, and Samson of Worcester are also known as Abacists. Finally, the term Abacists came to be applied to computers by manual arithmetic. A MS. Algorithm of the thirteenth century (Sl. 3281, f. 6, b), contains the following passage: "Est et alius modus secundum operatores sive practicos, quorum unus appellatur Abacus; et modus ejus est in computando per digitos et junctura manuum, et iste utitur ultra Alpes." In a composite treatise containing tracts written A.D. 1157 and 1208, on the calendar, the abacus, the manual calendar and the manual abacus, we have a number of the methods preserved. As an example we give the rule for multiplication (Claud. A. IV., f. 54 vo). "Si numerus multiplicat alium numerum auferatur differentia majoris a minore, et per residuum multiplicetur articulus, et una differentia per aliam, et summa proveniet." Example, 8 × 7. The difference of 8 is 2, of 7 is 3, the next article being 10; 7 - 2 is 5. 5 × 10 = 50; 2 × 3 = 6. 50 + 6 = 56 answer. The rule will hold in such cases as 17 × 15 where the article next higher is the same for both, _i.e._, 20; but in such a case as 17 × 9 the difference for each number must be taken from the higher article, _i.e._, the difference of 9 will be 11. THE ALGORISTS. Algorism (augrim, augrym, algram, agram, algorithm), owes its name to the accident that the first arithmetical treatise translated from the Arabic happened to be one written by Al-Khowarazmi in the early ninth century, "de numeris Indorum," beginning in its Latin form "Dixit Algorismi. . . ." The translation, of which only one MS. is known, was made about 1120 by Adelard of Bath, who also wrote on the Abacus and translated with a commentary Euclid from the Arabic. It is probable that another version was made by Gerard of Cremona (1114-1187); the number of important works that were not translated more than once from the Arabic decreases every year with our knowledge of medieval texts. A few lines of this translation, as copied by Halliwell, are given on p. 72, note 2. Another translation still seems to have been made by Johannes Hispalensis. Algorism is distinguished from Abacist computation by recognising seven rules, Addition, Subtraction, Duplation, Mediation, Multiplication, Division, and Extraction of Roots, to which were afterwards added Numeration and Progression. It is further distinguished by the use of the zero, which enabled the computer to dispense with the columns of the Abacus. It obviously employs a board with fine sand or wax, and later, as a substitute, paper or parchment; slate and pencil were also used in the fourteenth century, how much earlier is unknown.[5*] Algorism quickly ousted the Abacus methods for all intricate calculations, being simpler and more easily checked: in fact, the astronomical revival of the twelfth and thirteenth centuries would have been impossible without its aid. [Footnote 5*: Slates are mentioned by Chaucer, and soon after (1410) Prosdocimo de Beldamandi speaks of the use of a "lapis" for making notes on by calculators.] The number of Latin Algorisms still in manuscript is comparatively large, but we are here only concerned with two--an Algorism in prose attributed to Sacrobosco (John of Holywood) in the colophon of a Paris manuscript, though this attribution is no longer regarded as conclusive, and another in verse, most probably by Alexander de Villedieu (Villa Dei). Alexander, who died in 1240, was teaching in Paris in 1209. His verse treatise on the Calendar is dated 1200, and it is to that period that his Algorism may be attributed; Sacrobosco died in 1256 and quotes the verse Algorism. Several commentaries on Alexander's verse treatise were composed, from one of which our first tractate was translated, and the text itself was from time to time enlarged, sections on proofs and on mental arithmetic being added. We have no indication of the source on which Alexander drew; it was most likely one of the translations of Al-Khowarasmi, but he has also the Abacists in mind, as shewn by preserving the use of differences in multiplication. His treatise, first printed by Halliwell-Phillipps in his _Rara Mathematica_, is adapted for use on a board covered with sand, a method almost universal in the thirteenth century, as some passages in the algorism of that period already quoted show: "Est et alius modus qui utitur apud Indos, et doctor hujusmodi ipsos erat quidem nomine Algus. Et modus suus erat in computando per quasdam figuras scribendo in pulvere. . . ." "Si voluerimus depingere in pulvere predictos digitos secundum consuetudinem algorismi . . ." "et sciendum est quod in nullo loco minutorum sive secundorum . . . in pulvere debent scribi plusquam sexaginta." MODERN ARITHMETIC. Modern Arithmetic begins with Leonardi Fibonacci's treatise "de Abaco," written in 1202 and re-written in 1228. It is modern rather in the range of its problems and the methods of attack than in mere methods of calculation, which are of its period. Its sole interest as regards the present work is that Leonardi makes use of the digital signs described in Record's treatise on _The arte of nombrynge by the hand_ in mental arithmetic, calling it "modus Indorum." Leonardo also introduces the method of proof by "casting out the nines." DIGITAL ARITHMETIC. The method of indicating numbers by means of the fingers is of considerable age. The British Museum possesses two ivory counters marked on one side by carelessly scratched Roman numerals IIIV and VIIII, and on the other by carefully engraved digital signs for 8 and 9. Sixteen seems to have been the number of a complete set. These counters were either used in games or for the counting board, and the Museum ones, coming from the Hamilton collection, are undoubtedly not later than the first century. Frohner has published in the _Zeitschrift des Münchener Alterthumsvereins_ a set, almost complete, of them with a Byzantine treatise; a Latin treatise is printed among Bede's works. The use of this method is universal through the East, and a variety of it is found among many of the native races in Africa. In medieval Europe it was almost restricted to Italy and the Mediterranean basin, and in the treatise already quoted (Sloane 3281) it is even called the Abacus, perhaps a memory of Fibonacci's work. Methods of calculation by means of these signs undoubtedly have existed, but they were too involved and liable to error to be much used. THE USE OF "ARABIC" FIGURES. It may now be regarded as proved by Bubnov that our present numerals are derived from Greek sources through the so-called Boethian "apices," which are first found in late tenth century manuscripts. That they were not derived directly from the Arabic seems certain from the different shapes of some of the numerals, especially the 0, which stands for 5 in Arabic. Another Greek form existed, which was introduced into Europe by John of Basingstoke in the thirteenth century, and is figured by Matthew Paris (V. 285); but this form had no success. The date of the introduction of the zero has been hotly debated, but it seems obvious that the twelfth century Latin translators from the Arabic were perfectly well acquainted with the system they met in their Arabic text, while the earliest astronomical tables of the thirteenth century I have seen use numbers of European and not Arabic origin. The fact that Latin writers had a convenient way of writing hundreds and thousands without any cyphers probably delayed the general use of the Arabic notation. Dr. Hill has published a very complete survey of the various forms of numerals in Europe. They began to be common at the middle of the thirteenth century and a very interesting set of family notes concerning births in a British Museum manuscript, Harl. 4350 shows their extension. The first is dated Mij^c. lviii., the second Mij^c. lxi., the third Mij^c. 63, the fourth 1264, and the fifth 1266. Another example is given in a set of astronomical tables for 1269 in a manuscript of Roger Bacon's works, where the scribe began to write MCC6. and crossed out the figures, substituting the "Arabic" form. THE COUNTING BOARD. The treatise on pp. 52-65 is the only one in English known on the subject. It describes a method of calculation which, with slight modifications, is current in Russia, China, and Japan, to-day, though it went out of use in Western Europe by the seventeenth century. In Germany the method is called "Algorithmus Linealis," and there are several editions of a tract under this name (with a diagram of the counting board), printed at Leipsic at the end of the fifteenth century and the beginning of the sixteenth. They give the nine rules, but "Capitulum de radicum extractione ad algoritmum integrorum reservato, cujus species per ciffrales figuras ostenduntur ubi ad plenum de hac tractabitur." The invention of the art is there attributed to Appulegius the philosopher. The advantage of the counting board, whether permanent or constructed by chalking parallel lines on a table, as shown in some sixteenth-century woodcuts, is that only five counters are needed to indicate the number nine, counters on the lines representing units, and those in the spaces above representing five times those on the line below. The Russian abacus, the "tchatui" or "stchota" has ten beads on the line; the Chinese and Japanese "Swanpan" economises by dividing the line into two parts, the beads on one side representing five times the value of those on the other. The "Swanpan" has usually many more lines than the "stchota," allowing for more extended calculations, see Tylor, _Anthropology_ (1892), p. 314. Record's treatise also mentions another method of counter notation (p. 64) "merchants' casting" and "auditors' casting." These were adapted for the usual English method of reckoning numbers up to 200 by scores. This method seems to have been used in the Exchequer. A counting board for merchants' use is printed by Halliwell in _Rara Mathematica_ (p. 72) from Sloane MS. 213, and two others are figured in Egerton 2622 f. 82 and f. 83. The latter is said to be "novus modus computandi secundum inventionem Magistri Thome Thorleby," and is in principle, the same as the "Swanpan." The Exchequer table is described in the _Dialogus de Scaccario_ (Oxford, 1902), p. 38. +The Earliest Arithmetics in English.+ +The Crafte of Nombrynge+ _Egerton 2622._ [*leaf 136a] Hec algorism{us} ars p{re}sens dicit{ur}; in qua Talib{us} indor{um} fruim{ur} bis qui{n}q{ue} figuris. [Sidenote: A derivation of Algorism. Another derivation of the word.] This boke is called že boke of algorym, or Augrym aft{er} lewd{er} vse. And žis boke tretys že Craft of Nombryng, že quych crafte is called also Algorym. Ther was a kyng of Inde, že quich heyth Algor, & he made žis craft. And aft{er} his name he called hit algory{m}; or els anož{er} cause is quy it is called Algorym, for že latyn word of hit s. Algorism{us} com{es} of Algos, grece, q{uid} e{st} ars, latine, craft o[n~] englis, and rides, q{uid} e{st} {nu}me{rus}, latine, A nomb{ur} o[n~] englys, inde d{icitu}r Algorism{us} p{er} addic{i}one{m} hui{us} sillabe m{us} & subtracc{i}onem d & e, q{ua}si ars num{er}andi. ¶ fforthermor{e} [gh]e most vnd{ir}stonde ž{a}t in žis craft ben vsid teen figurys, as here ben{e} writen for ensampul, +0+ 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1. ¶ Expone že too v{er}sus afor{e}: this p{re}sent craft ys called Algorism{us}, in že quych we vse teen signys of Inde. Questio. ¶ Why te[n~] fyguris of Inde? Solucio. for as I haue sayd afore žai wer{e} fonde fyrst in Inde of a kyng{e} of žat Cuntre, ž{a}t was called Algor. [Headnote: Notation and Numeration.] [Sidenote: v{ersus} [in margin].] ¶ Prima sig{nifica}t unu{m}; duo ve{r}o s{e}c{un}da: ¶ Tercia sig{nifica}t tria; sic procede sinistre. ¶ Don{e}c ad extrema{m} venias, que cifra voca{tur}. +¶ Cap{itulu}m primum de significac{i}o{n}e figurar{um}.+ [Sidenote: Expo{sitio} v{ersus}.] [Sidenote: The meaning and place of the figures. Which figure is read first.] In žis verse is notifide že significac{i}on of žese figur{is}. And žus expone the verse. Že first signifiyth on{e}, že secu{n}de [*leaf 136b] signi[*]fiyth tweyn{e}, že thryd signifiyth thre, & the fourte signifiyth 4. ¶ And so forthe towarde že lyft syde of že tabul or of že boke ž{a}t že figures ben{e} writen{e} in, til žat ž{o}u come to the last figure, ž{a}t is called a cifre. ¶ Questio. In quych syde sittes že first figur{e}? Soluc{io}, forsothe loke quich figure is first in že ry[gh]t side of že bok or of že tabul, & ž{a}t same is že first figur{e}, for ž{o}u schal write bakeward, as here, 3. 2. 6. 4. 1. 2. 5. The fig{ur}e of 5. was first write, & he is že first, for he sittes o[n~] že ri[gh]t syde. And the fig{ur}e of 3 is last. ¶ Neu{er}-že-les wen he says ¶ P{ri}ma sig{nifica}t vnu{m} &c., žat is to say, že first betokenes on{e}, že secu{n}de. 2. & fore-ž{er}-mor{e}, he vnd{ir}stondes no[gh]t of že first fig{ur}e of eu{er}y rew. ¶ But he vnd{ir}stondes že first figure ž{a}t is in že nomb{ur} of že forsayd teen figuris, že quych is on{e} of ž{e}se. 1. And že secu{n}de 2. & so forth. [Sidenote: v{ersus} [in margin].] ¶ Quelib{et} illar{um} si pr{im}o limite ponas, ¶ Simplicite{r} se significat: si v{er}o se{cun}do, Se decies: sursu{m} {pr}ocedas m{u}ltiplicando. ¶ Na{m}q{ue} figura seque{n}s q{uam}uis signat decies pl{us}. ¶ Ipsa locata loco quam sign{ific}at p{ertin}ente. [Transcriber's Note: In the following section, numerals shown in +marks+ were printed in a different font, possibly as facsimiles of the original MS form.] [Sidenote: Expo{sitio} [in margin].] [Sidenote: An explanation of the principles of notation. An example: units, tens, hundreds, thousands. How to read the number.] ¶ Expone žis v{er}se žus. Eu{er}y of žese figuris bitokens hym selfe & no mor{e}, yf he stonde in že first place of že rewele / this worde Simplicit{er} in žat verse it is no more to say but žat, & no mor{e}. ¶ If it stonde in the secu{n}de place of že rewle, he betokens ten{e} tymes hym selfe, as žis figur{e} 2 here 20 tokens ten tyme hym selfe, [*leaf 137a] žat is twenty, for he hym selfe betokenes twey{ne}, & ten tymes twene is twenty. And for he stondis o[n~] že lyft side & in že secu{n}de place, he betokens ten tyme hy{m} selfe. And so go forth. ¶ ffor eu{er}y fig{ure}, & he stonde aft{ur} a-nož{er} toward the lyft side, he schal betoken{e} ten tymes as mich mor{e} as he schul betoken & he stode in že place ž{ere} žat že fig{ure} a-for{e} hym stondes. loo an ensampull{e}. 9. 6. 3. 4. Že fig{ure} of 4. ž{a}t hase žis schape +4.+ betokens bot hymselfe, for he stondes in že first place. The fig{ure} of 3. žat hase žis schape +3.+ betokens ten tymes mor{e} žen he schuld & he stode ž{ere} ž{a}t že fig{ure} of 4. stondes, ž{a}t is thretty. The fig{ure} of 6, ž{a}t hase žis schape +6+, betokens ten tymes mor{e} žan he schuld & he stode ž{ere} as že fig{ure} of +3.+ stondes, for ž{ere} he schuld tokyn{e} bot sexty, & now he betokens ten tymes mor{e}, žat is sex hundryth. The fig{ure} of 9. ž{a}t hase žis schape +9.+ betokens ten tymes mor{e} žan{e} he schuld & he stode in že place ž{ere} že fig{ure} of sex stondes, for žen he schuld betoken to 9. hundryth, and in že place ž{ere} he stondes now he betokens 9. žousande. Al že hole nomb{ur} is 9 thousande sex hundryth & four{e} & thretty. ¶ fforthermor{e}, when ž{o}u schalt rede a nomb{ur} of fig{ure}, ž{o}u schalt begyn{e} at že last fig{ure} in the lyft side, & rede so forth to že ri[gh]t side as her{e} 9. 6. 3. 4. Thou schal begyn to rede at že fig{ure} of 9. & rede forth žus. 9. [*leaf 137b] thousand sex hundryth thritty & foure. But when ž{o}u schall{e} write, ž{o}u schalt be-gynne to write at že ry[gh]t side. ¶ Nil cifra sig{nifica}t s{ed} dat signa{re} sequenti. [Sidenote: The meaning and use of the cipher.] Expone žis v{er}se. A cifre tokens no[gh]t, bot he makes že fig{ure} to betoken žat comes aft{ur} hym mor{e} žan he schuld & he wer{e} away, as žus 1+0+. her{e} že fig{ure} of on{e} tokens ten, & yf že cifre wer{e} away[{1}] & no fig{ure} by-for{e} hym he schuld token bot on{e}, for žan he sch{ul}d stonde in že first place. ¶ And že cifre tokens nothyng hym selfe. for al že nomb{ur} of že ylke too fig{ure}s is bot ten. ¶ Questio. Why says he žat a cifre makys a fig{ure} to signifye (tyf) mor{e} &c. ¶ I speke for žis worde significatyf, ffor sothe it may happe aft{ur} a cifre schuld come a-nož{ur} cifre, as žus 2+0++0+. And [gh]et že secunde cifre shuld token neu{er} že mor{e} excep he schuld kepe že ord{er} of že place. and a cifre is no fig{ure} significatyf. +¶ Q{ua}m p{re}cedentes plus ulti{m}a significabit+ / [Sidenote: The last figure means more than all the others, since it is of the highest value.] Expone žis v{er}se žus. Že last figu{re} schal token mor{e} žan all{e} že ož{er} afor{e}, thou[gh]t ž{ere} wer{e} a hundryth thousant figures afor{e}, as žus, 16798. Že last fig{ure} žat is 1. betokens ten thousant. And all{e} že ož{er} fig{ure}s b{e}n bot betoken{e} bot sex thousant seuyn{e} h{u}ndryth nynty & 8. ¶ And ten thousant is mor{e} žen all{e} žat nomb{ur}, {er}go že last figu{re} tokens mor{e} žan all že nomb{ur} afor{e}. [Headnote: The Three Kinds of Numbers] [*leaf 138a] ¶ Post p{re}dicta scias breuit{er} q{uod} tres num{er}or{um} Distincte species sunt; nam quidam digiti sunt; Articuli quidam; quidam q{uoque} compositi sunt. ¶ Capit{ulu}m 2^m de t{ri}plice divisione nu{mer}or{um}. [Sidenote: Digits. Articles. Composites.] ¶ The auctor of žis tretis dep{ar}tys žis worde a nomb{ur} into 3 p{ar}tes. Some nomb{ur} is called digit{us} latine, a digit in englys. So{m}me nomb{ur} is called articul{us} latine. An Articul in englys. Some nomb{ur} is called a composyt in englys. ¶ Expone žis v{er}se. know ž{o}u aft{ur} že forsayd rewles ž{a}t I sayd afore, žat ž{ere} ben thre spices of nomb{ur}. Oon{e} is a digit, Anož{er} is an Articul, & že tož{er} a Composyt. v{er}sus. [Headnote: Digits, Articles, and Composites.] ¶ Sunt digiti num{er}i qui cit{ra} denariu{m} s{u}nt. [Sidenote: What are digits.] ¶ Her{e} he telles qwat is a digit, Expone v{er}su{s} sic. Nomb{ur}s digitus ben{e} all{e} nomb{ur}s žat ben w{i}t{h}-inne ten, as nyne, 8. 7. 6. 5. 4. 3. 2. 1. ¶ Articupli decupli degito{rum}; compositi s{u}nt Illi qui constant ex articulis degitisq{ue}. [Sidenote: What are articles.] ¶ Her{e} he telles what is a composyt and what is an{e} articul. Expone sic v{er}sus. ¶ Articulis ben[{2}] all{e} ž{a}t may be deuidyt into nomb{urs} of ten & nothyng{e} leue ou{er}, as twenty, thretty, fourty, a hundryth, a thousand, & such ož{er}, ffor twenty may be dep{ar}tyt in-to 2 nomb{ur}s of ten, fforty in to four{e} nomb{ur}s of ten, & so forth. [Sidenote: What numbers are composites.] [*leaf 138b] Compositys be[n~] nomb{ur}s žat bene componyt of a digyt & of an articull{e} as fouretene, fyftene, sextene, & such ož{er}. ffortene is co{m}ponyd of four{e} žat is a digit & of ten žat is an articull{e}. ffiftene is componyd of 5 & ten, & so of all ož{er}, what žat žai ben. Short-lych eu{er}y nomb{ur} žat be-gynnes w{i}t{h} a digit & endyth in a articull{e} is a composyt, as fortene bygennyng{e} by four{e} žat is a digit, & endes in ten. ¶ Ergo, p{ro}posito nu{mer}o tibi scriber{e}, p{ri}mo Respicias quid sit nu{merus}; si digitus sit P{ri}mo scribe loco digitu{m}, si compositus sit P{ri}mo scribe loco digitu{m} post articulu{m}; sic. [Sidenote: How to write a number, if it is a digit; if it is a composite. How to read it.] ¶ here he telles how ž{o}u schalt wyrch whan ž{o}u schalt write a nomb{ur}. Expone v{er}su{m} sic, & fac iuxta expon{ent}is sentencia{m}; whan ž{o}u hast a nomb{ur} to write, loke fyrst what man{er} nomb{ur} it ys ž{a}t ž{o}u schalt write, whether it be a digit or a composit or an Articul. ¶ If he be a digit, write a digit, as yf it be seuen, write seuen & write ž{a}t digit in že first place toward že ryght side. If it be a composyt, write že digit of že composit in že first place & write že articul of žat digit in že secunde place next toward že lyft side. As yf ž{o}u schal write sex & twenty. write že digit of že nomb{ur} in že first place žat is sex, and write že articul next aft{ur} žat is twenty, as žus 26. But whan ž{o}u schalt sowne or speke [*leaf 139a] or rede an Composyt žou schalt first sowne že articul & aft{ur} že digit, as ž{o}u seyst by že comyn{e} speche, Sex & twenty & nou[gh]t twenty & sex. v{er}sus. ¶ Articul{us} si sit, in p{ri}mo limite cifram, Articulu{m} {vero} reliq{ui}s insc{ri}be figur{is}. [Sidenote: How to write Articles: tens, hundreds, thousands, &c.] ¶ Here he tells how ž{o}u schal write when že nombre ž{a}t ž{o}u hase to write is an Articul. Expone v{er}sus sic & fac s{ecundu}m sentenciam. Ife že nomb{ur} ž{a}t ž{o}u hast write be an Articul, write first a cifre & aft{ur} že cifer write an Articull{e} žus. 2+0+. fforthermor{e} ž{o}u schalt vnd{ir}stonde yf ž{o}u haue an Articul, loke how mych he is, yf he be w{i}t{h}-ynne an hundryth, ž{o}u schalt write bot on{e} cifre, afore, as her{e} .9+0+. If že articull{e} be by hym-silfe & be an hundrid euen{e}, žen schal ž{o}u write .1. & 2 cifers afor{e}, žat he may stonde in že thryd place, for eu{er}y fig{ure} in že thryd place schal token a hundrid tymes hym selfe. If že articul be a thousant or thousandes[{3}] and he stonde by hy{m} selfe, write afor{e} 3 cifers & so forž of al ož{er}. ¶ Quolib{et} in nu{mer}o, si par sit p{ri}ma figura, Par erit & to{tu}m, quicquid sibi co{n}ti{nua}t{ur}; Imp{ar} si fu{er}it, totu{m} tu{n}c fiet {et} impar. [Sidenote: To tell an even number or an odd.] ¶ Her{e} he teches a gen{er}all{e} rewle ž{a}t yf že first fig{ure} in že rewle of fig{ure}s token a nomb{ur} žat is euen{e} al ž{a}t nomb{ur} of fig{ur}ys in žat rewle schal be euen{e}, as her{e} ž{o}u may see 6. 7. 3. 5. 4. Computa & p{ro}ba. ¶ If že first [*leaf 139b] fig{ur}e token an nomb{ur} žat is ode, all{e} žat nomb{ur} in žat rewle schall{e} be ode, as her{e} 5 6 7 8 6 7. Computa & p{ro}ba. v{er}sus. ¶ Septe{m} su{n}t partes, no{n} pl{u}res, istius artis; ¶ Adder{e}, subt{ra}her{e}, duplar{e}, dimidiar{e}, Sextaq{ue} diuider{e}, s{ed} qui{n}ta m{u}ltiplicar{e}; Radice{m} ext{ra}her{e} p{ar}s septi{m}a dicitur esse. [Headnote: The Seven Rules of Arithmetic.] [Sidenote: The seven rules.] ¶ Her{e} telles ž{a}t ž{er} be[n~] .7. spices or p{ar}tes of žis craft. The first is called addicioń, že secunde is called subtraccioń. The thryd is called duplacioń. The 4. is called dimydicioń. The 5. is called m{u}ltiplicacioń. The 6 is called diuisioń. The 7. is called extraccioń of že Rote. What all žese spices ben{e} hit schall{e} be tolde singillati{m} in her{e} caputul{e}. ¶ Subt{ra}his aut addis a dext{ri}s vel mediabis: [Sidenote: Add, subtract, or halve, from right to left.] Thou schal be-gynne in že ryght side of že boke or of a tabul. loke wer{e} ž{o}u wul be-gynne to write latyn or englys in a boke, & ž{a}t schall{e} be called že lyft side of the boke, žat ž{o}u writest toward ž{a}t side schal be called že ryght side of že boke. V{er}sus. A leua dupla, diuide, m{u}ltiplica. [Sidenote: Multiply or divide from left to right.] Here he telles že in quych side of že boke or of že tabul ž{o}u schall{e} be-gyn{e} to wyrch duplacioń, diuisioń, and m{u}ltiplicacioń. Thou schal begyn{e} to worch in že lyft side of že boke or of že tabul, but yn what wyse ž{o}u schal wyrch in hym +dicetur singillatim in seque{n}tib{us} capi{tulis} et de vtilitate cui{us}li{bet} art{is} & sic Completur [*leaf 140.] p{ro}hemi{um} & sequit{ur} tractat{us} & p{ri}mo de arte addic{ion}is que p{ri}ma ars est in ordine.+ [Headnote: The Craft of Addition.] ++Adder{e} si nu{mer}o num{e}ru{m} vis, ordine tali Incipe; scribe duas p{rim}o series nu{mer}or{um} P{ri}ma{m} sub p{ri}ma recte pone{n}do figura{m}, Et sic de reliq{ui}s facias, si sint tibi plures. [Sidenote: Four things must be known: what it is; how many rows of figures; how many cases; what is its result. How to set down the sum.] ¶ Her{e} by-gynnes že craft of Addicioń. In žis craft ž{o}u most knowe foure thyng{es}. ¶ Fyrst ž{ou} most know what is addicioń. Next ž{o}u most know how mony rewles of figurys žou most haue. ¶ Next ž{o}u most know how mony diue{r}s casys happes in žis craft of addicioń. ¶ And next qwat is že p{ro}fet of žis craft. ¶ As for že first žou most know žat addicioń is a castyng to-ged{ur} of twoo nomburys in-to on{e} nombr{e}. As yf I aske qwat is twene & thre. Ž{o}u wyl cast žese twene nomb{re}s to-ged{ur} & say ž{a}t it is fyue. ¶ As for že secunde žou most know ž{a}t žou schall{e} haue tweyne rewes of figures, on{e} vndur a-nother, as her{e} ž{o}u mayst se. 1234 2168. ¶ As for že thryd žou most know ž{a}t ther{e} ben foure diu{er}se cases. As for že forthe ž{o}u most know ž{a}t že p{ro}fet of žis craft is to telle what is že hole nomb{ur} ž{a}t comes of diu{er}se nomburis. Now as to že texte of oure verse, he teches ther{e} how ž{o}u schal worch in žis craft. ¶ He says yf ž{o}u wilt cast on{e} nomb{ur} to anož{er} nomb{ur}, žou most by-gynne on žis wyse. ¶ ffyrst write [*leaf 140b] two rewes of figuris & nombris so žat ž{o}u write že first figur{e} of že hyer nomb{ur} euen{e} vnd{ir} the first fig{ure} of že nether nomb{ur}, And že secunde of že nether nomb{ur} euen{e} vnd{ir} že secunde of že hyer, & so forthe of eu{er}y fig{ur}e of both že rewes as ž{o}u mayst se. 123 234. [Headnote: The Cases of the Craft of Addition.] ¶ Inde duas adde p{ri}mas hac condic{i}one: Si digitus crescat ex addic{i}one prior{um}; P{ri}mo scribe loco digitu{m}, quicu{n}q{ue} sit ille. [Sidenote: Add the first figures; rub out the top figure; write the result in its place. Here is an example.] ¶ Here he teches what ž{o}u schalt do when ž{o}u hast write too rewes of figuris on vnder an-ož{er}, as I sayd be-for{e}. ¶ He says ž{o}u schalt take že first fig{ur}e of že heyer nomb{re} & že fyrst figur{e} of že než{er} nombre, & cast hem to-ged{er} vp-on žis condicio[n~]. Thou schal loke qwež{er} že nombe{r} žat comys ž{ere}-of be a digit or no. ¶ If he be a digit ž{o}u schalt do away že first fig{ur}e of že hyer nomb{re}, and write ž{ere} in his stede žat he stode Inne že digit, ž{a}t comes of že ylke 2 fig{ur}es, & so wrich forth o[n~] ož{er} figures yf ž{ere} be ony moo, til ž{o}u come to že ende toward že lyft side. And lede že nether fig{ure} stonde still eu{er}-mor{e} til ž{o}u haue ydo. ffor ž{ere}-by ž{o}u schal wyte whež{er} ž{o}u hast don{e} wel or no, as I schal tell že aft{er}ward in že ende of žis Chapt{er}. ¶ And loke allgate žat žou be-gynne to worch in žis Craft of [*leaf 141a] Addi[*]cio[n~] in že ry[gh]t side, here is an ensampul of žis case. 1234 2142. Caste 2 to four{e} & žat wel be sex, do away 4. & write in že same place že fig{ur}e of sex. ¶ And lete že fig{ur}e of 2 in že nether rewe stonde stil. When ž{o}u hast do so, cast 3 & 4 to-ged{ur} and žat wel be seuen ž{a}t is a digit. Do away že 3, & set ž{ere} seue[n~], and lete že než{er} fig{ure} stonde still{e}, & so worch forth bakward til ž{o}u hast ydo all to-ged{er}. Et si composit{us}, in limite scribe seque{n}te Articulum, p{ri}mo digitum; q{uia} sic iubet ordo. [Sidenote: Suppose it is a Composite, set down the digit, and carry the tens. Here is an example.] ¶ Here is že secunde case ž{a}t may happe in žis craft. And že case is žis, yf of že casting of 2 nomburis to-ged{er}, as of že fig{ur}e of že hyer rewe & of že figure of že než{er} rewe come a Composyt, how schalt ž{ou} worch. Ž{us} ž{o}u schalt worch. Thou shalt do away že fig{ur}e of že hyer nomb{er} žat was cast to že figure of že než{er} nomber. ¶ And write ž{ere} že digit of že Composyt. And set že articul of že composit next aft{er} že digit in že same rewe, yf ž{ere} be no mo fig{ur}es aft{er}. But yf ž{ere} be mo figuris aft{er} žat digit. And žere he schall be rekend for hym selfe. And when ž{o}u schalt adde ž{a}t ylke figure ž{a}t berys že articull{e} ou{er} his hed to že figur{e} vnd{er} hym, ž{o}u schalt cast žat articul to že figure ž{a}t hase hym ou{er} his hed, & ž{ere} žat Articul schal toke[n~] hym selfe. lo an Ensampull [*leaf 141b] of all. 326 216. Cast 6 to 6, & ž{ere}-of wil arise twelue. do away že hyer 6 & write ž{ere} 2, ž{a}t is že digit of žis composit. And že{n} write že articull{e} žat is ten ou{er} že figuris hed of twene as ž{us}. 1 322 216. Now cast že articull{e} ž{a}t standus vpon že fig{ur}is of twene hed to že same fig{ur}e, & reken žat articul bot for on{e}, and žan ž{ere} wil arise thre. Žan cast žat thre to že než{er} figure, žat is on{e}, & žat wul be four{e}. do away že fig{ur}e of 3, and write ž{ere} a fig{ur}e of foure. and lete že než{er} fig{ur}e stonde stil, & žan worch forth. vn{de} {ver}sus. ¶ Articulus si sit, in p{ri}mo limite cifram, ¶ Articulu{m} v{er}o reliquis inscribe figuris, Vel p{er} se scribas si nulla figura sequat{ur}. [Sidenote: Suppose it is an Article, set down a cipher and carry the tens. Here is an example.] ¶ Her{e} he puttes že thryde case of že craft of Addicio[n~]. & že case is žis. yf of Addiciou[n~] of 2 figuris a-ryse an Articull{e}, how schal ž{o}u do. thou most do away že heer fig{ur}e ž{a}t was addid to že než{er}, & write ž{ere} a cifre, and sett že articuls on že figuris hede, yf ž{a}t ž{ere} come ony aft{er}. And wyrch žan as I haue tolde že in že secunde case. An ensampull. 25. 15 Cast 5 to 5, žat wylle be ten. now do away že hyer 5, & write ž{ere} a cifer. And sette ten vpon že figuris hed of 2. And reken it but for on žus.] lo an Ensampull{e} +----+ | 1 | | 2+0+ | | 15 | +----+ And [*leaf 142a] žan worch forth. But yf ž{ere} come no figure aft{er} že cifre, write že articul next hym in že same rewe as here +---+ | 5 | | 5 | +---+ cast 5 to 5, and it wel be ten. do away 5. žat is že hier 5. and write ž{ere} a cifre, & write aft{er} hym že articul as žus +----+ | 1+0+ | | 5 | +----+ And žan ž{o}u hast done. ¶ Si tibi cifra sup{er}ueniens occurrerit, illa{m} Dele sup{er}posita{m}; fac illic scribe figura{m}, Postea procedas reliquas addendo figuras. [Sidenote: What to do when you have a cipher in the top row. An example of all the difficulties.] ¶ Her{e} he putt{es} že fourt case, & it is žis, žat yf ž{ere} come a cifer in že hier rewe, how ž{o}u schal do. žus ž{o}u schalt do. do away že cifer, & sett ž{ere} že digit ž{a}t comes of že addiciou{n} as žus 1+0++0+84. 17743 In žis ensampul ben all{e} že four{e} cases. Cast 3 to foure, ž{a}t wol be seue[n~]. do away 4. & write ž{ere} seue[n~]; žan cast 4 to že figur{e} of 8. ž{a}t wel be 12. do away 8, & sett ž{ere} 2. žat is a digit, and sette že articul of že composit, žat is ten, vpon že cifers hed, & reken it for hym selfe žat is on. žan cast on{e} to a cifer, & hit wull{e} be but on, for no[gh]t & on makes but on{e}. žan cast 7. ž{a}t stondes vnd{er} žat on to hym, & žat wel be 8. do away že cifer & žat 1. & sette ž{ere} 8. žan go forthermor{e}. cast že ož{er} 7 to že cifer ž{a}t stondes ou{er} hy{m}. ž{a}t wul be bot seuen, for že cifer betokens no[gh]t. do away že cifer & sette ž{ere} seue[n~], [*leaf 142b] & žen go forž{er}mor{e} & cast 1 to 1, & žat wel be 2. do away že hier 1, & sette ž{ere} 2. žan hast ž{o}u do. And yf ž{o}u haue wel ydo žis nomber žat is sett her{e}-aft{er} wel be že nomber žat schall{e} aryse of all{e} že addicio[n~] as her{e} 27827. ¶ Sequi{tu}r alia sp{eci}es. [Headnote: The Craft of Subtraction.] ++A nu{mer}o num{er}u{m} si sit tibi demer{e} cura Scribe figurar{um} series, vt in addicione. [Sidenote: Four things to know about subtraction: the first; the second; the third; the fourth.] ¶ This is že Chapt{er} of subtraccio[n~], in the quych žou most know foure nessessary thyng{es}. the first what is subtraccio[n~]. že secunde is how mony nombers žou most haue to subt{ra}ccio[n~], the thryd is how mony maners of cases ž{ere} may happe in žis craft of subtraccio[n~]. The fourte is qwat is že p{ro}fet of žis craft. ¶ As for že first, ž{o}u most know ž{a}t subtraccio[n~] is drawyng{e} of on{e} nowmb{er} oute of anož{er} nomber. As for že secunde, žou most knowe ž{a}t žou most haue two rewes of figuris on{e} vnd{er} anož{er}, as ž{o}u addyst in addicio[n~]. As for že thryd, ž{o}u moyst know ž{a}t four{e} man{er} of diu{er}se casis mai happe in žis craft. ¶ As for že fourt, žou most know ž{a}t že p{ro}fet of žis craft is whenne ž{o}u hasse taken že lasse nomber out of že mor{e} to telle what ž{ere} leues ou{er} ž{a}t. & ž{o}u most be-gynne to wyrch in ž{is} craft in že ryght side of že boke, as ž{o}u diddyst in addicio[n~]. V{er}sus. ¶ Maiori nu{mer}o num{er}u{m} suppone minorem, ¶ Siue pari nu{mer}o supponat{ur} num{er}us par. [Sidenote: Put the greater number above the less.] [*leaf 143a] ¶ Her{e} he telles žat že hier nomber most be mor{e} žen že než{er}, or els eue[n~] as mych. but he may not be lasse. And že case is žis, žou schalt drawe že než{er} nomber out of že hyer, & žou mayst not do ž{a}t yf že hier nomber wer{e} lasse žan žat. ffor ž{o}u mayst not draw sex out of 2. But ž{o}u mast draw 2 out of sex. And žou maiste draw twene out of twene, for žou schal leue no[gh]t of že hier twene vn{de} v{er}sus. [Headnote: The Cases of the Craft of Subtraction.] ¶ Postea si possis a prima subt{ra}he p{ri}ma{m} Scribens quod remanet. [Sidenote: The first case of subtraction. Here is an example.] Her{e} is že first case put of subtraccio[n~], & he says žou schalt begynne in že ryght side, & draw že first fig{ure} of že než{er} rewe out of že first fig{ure} of že hier rewe. qwether že hier fig{ur}e be mor{e} žen že než{er}, or eue[n~] as mych. And žat is notified in že vers when he says "Si possis." Whan ž{o}u has žus ydo, do away že hiest fig{ur}e & sett ž{ere} žat leues of že subtraccio[n~], lo an Ensampull{e} +-----+ | 234 | | 122 | +-----+ draw 2 out of 4. žan leues 2. do away 4 & write ž{ere} 2, & latte že než{er} figur{e} sto{n}de stille, & so go for-by ož{er} figuris till ž{o}u come to že ende, žan hast ž{o}u do. ¶ Cifram si nil remanebit. [Sidenote: Put a cipher if nothing remains. Here is an example.] ¶ Her{e} he putt{es} že secunde case, & hit is žis. yf it happe ž{a}t qwen ž{o}u hast draw on než{er} fig{ure} out of a hier, & ž{er}e leue no[gh]t aft{er} že subt{ra}ccio[n~], žus [*leaf 143b] žou schalt do. ž{o}u schall{e} do away že hier fig{ur}e & write ž{ere} a cifer, as lo an Ensampull +----+ | 24 | | 24 | +----+ Take four{e} out of four{e} žan leus no[gh]t. ž{er}efor{e} do away že hier 4 & set ž{ere} a cifer, žan take 2 out of 2, žan leues no[gh]t. do away že hier 2, & set ž{ere} a cifer, and so worch whar{e} so eu{er} žis happe. Sed si no{n} possis a p{ri}ma dem{er}e p{ri}ma{m} P{re}cedens vnu{m} de limite deme seque{n}te, Quod demptu{m} p{ro} denario reputabis ab illo Subt{ra}he to{ta}lem num{er}u{m} qu{em} p{ro}posuisti Quo facto sc{ri}be super quicquid remaneb{i}t. [Sidenote: Suppose you cannot take the lower figure from the top one, borrow ten; take the lower number from ten; add the answer to the top number. How to 'Pay back' the borrowed ten. Example.] Her{e} he puttes že thryd case, že quych is žis. yf it happe žat že než{er} fig{ur}e be mor{e} žen že hier fig{ur}e žat he schall{e} be draw out of. how schall{e} žou do. žus ž{o}u schall{e} do. žou schall{e} borro .1. oute of že next fig{ur}e žat comes aft{er} in že same rewe, for žis case may neu{er} happ but yf ž{ere} come figures aft{er}. žan ž{o}u schalt sett žat on ou{er} že hier figur{es} hed, of the quych žou woldist y-draw oute že neyž{er} fig{ur}e yf ž{o}u haddyst y-my[gh]t. Whane žou hase žus ydo žou schall{e} rekene ž{a}t .1. for ten. ¶. And out of žat ten ž{o}u schal draw že neyžermost fig{ur}e, And all{e} ž{a}t leues žou schall{e} adde to že figur{e} on whos hed žat .1. stode. And žen ž{o}u schall{e} do away all{e} žat, & sett ž{ere} all{e} that arisys of the addicio[n~] of že ylke 2 fig{ur}is. And yf yt [*leaf 144a] happe žat že fig{ur}e of že quych ž{o}u schalt borro on be hym self but 1. If ž{o}u schalt žat on{e} & sett it vppo[n~] že ož{er} figur{is} hed, and sett in ž{a}t 1. place a cifer, yf ž{ere} come mony figur{es} aft{er}. lo an Ensampul. +------+ | 2122 | | 1134 | +------+ take 4 out of 2. it wyl not be, žerfor{e} borro on{e} of že next figur{e}, ž{a}t is 2. and sett žat ou{er} že hed of že fyrst 2. & rekene it for ten. and žere že secunde stondes write 1. for ž{o}u tokest on out of hy{m}. žan take že než{er} fig{ur}e, žat is 4, out of ten. And žen leues 6. cast to 6 že fig{ur}e of žat 2 žat stode vnd{er} že hedde of 1. žat was borwed & rekened for ten, and žat wylle be 8. do away ž{a}t 6 & žat 2, & sette ž{ere} 8, & lette že než{er} fig{ur}e stonde stille. Whanne ž{o}u hast do žus, go to že next fig{ur}e ž{a}t is now bot 1. but first yt was 2, & ž{ere}-of was borred 1. žan take out of ž{a}t že fig{ur}e vnd{er} hym, ž{a}t is 3. hit wel not be. žer-for{e} borowe of the next fig{ur}e, že quych is bot 1. Also take & sett hym ou{er} že hede of že fig{ure} žat žou woldest haue y-draw oute of že nether figure, že quych was 3. & žou my[gh]t not, & rekene ž{a}t borwed 1 for ten & sett in že same place, of že quych place ž{o}u tokest hy{m} of, a cifer, for he was bot 1. Whanne ž{o}u hast ž{us} ydo, take out of žat 1. ž{a}t is rekent for ten, že než{er} figure of 3. And ž{ere} leues 7. [*leaf 144b] cast že ylke 7 to že fig{ur}e žat had že ylke ten vpon his hed, že quych fig{ur}e was 1, & žat wol be 8. žan do away ž{a}t 1 and ž{a}t 7, & write ž{ere} 8. & žan wyrch forth in ož{er} figuris til ž{o}u come to že ende, & žan ž{o}u hast že do. V{er}sus. ¶ Facque nonenarios de cifris, cu{m} remeabis ¶ Occ{ur}rant si forte cifre; dum demps{er}is vnum ¶ Postea p{ro}cedas reliquas deme{n}do figuras. [Sidenote: A very hard case is put. Here is an example.] ¶ Her{e} he putt{es} že fourte case, že quych is žis, yf it happe žat že než{er} fig{ur}e, že quych ž{o}u schalt draw out of že hier fig{ur}e be mor{e} pan že hier figur ou{er} hym, & že next fig{ur}e of two or of thre or of foure, or how mony ž{ere} be by cifers, how wold ž{o}u do. Ž{o}u wost wel ž{o}u most nede borow, & ž{o}u mayst not borow of že cifers, for žai haue no[gh]t žat žai may lene or spar{e}. Ergo[{4}] how woldest ž{o}u do. Certay[n~] žus most ž{o}u do, ž{o}u most borow on of že next figure significatyf in žat rewe, for žis case may not happe, but yf ž{ere} come figures significatyf aft{er} the cifers. Whan ž{o}u hast borowede ž{a}t 1 of the next figure significatyf, sett ž{a}t on ou{er} že hede of ž{a}t fig{ur}e of že quych ž{o}u wold haue draw že než{er} figure out yf ž{o}u hadest my[gh]t, & reken it for ten as žo{u} diddest i{n} že ož{er} case her{e}-a-for{e}. Wha[n~] ž{o}u hast žus y-do loke how mony cifers ž{ere} wer{e} bye-twene žat figur{e} significatyf, & že fig{ur}e of že quych ž{o}u woldest haue y-draw the [*leaf 145a] než{er} figure, and of eu{er}y of že ylke cifers make a figur{e} of 9. lo an Ensampull{e} after. +-----+ |40002| |10004| +-----+ Take 4 out of 2. it wel not be. borow 1 out of be next figure significatyf, že quych is 4, & žen leues 3. do away ž{a}t figur{e} of 4 & write ž{ere} 3. & sett ž{a}t 1 vppon že fig{ur}e of 2 hede, & žan take 4 out of ten, & žan žere leues 6. Cast 6 to the fig{ur}e of 2, ž{a}t wol be 8. do away žat 6 & write ž{er}e 8. Whan ž{o}u hast žus y-do make of eu{er}y 0 betweyn 3 & 8 a figure of 9, & žan worch forth in goddes name. & yf ž{o}u hast wel y-do ž{o}u[{5}] schalt haue žis nomb{er} +-----+ |39998| Sic. |10004| +-----+ [Headnote: How to prove the Subtraction.] ¶ Si subt{ra}cc{i}o sit b{e}n{e} facta p{ro}bar{e} valebis Quas s{u}btraxisti p{ri}mas addendo figuras. [Sidenote: How to prove a subtraction sum. Here is an example. He works his proof through, and brings out a result.] ¶ Her{e} he teches že Craft how ž{o}u schalt know, whan ž{o}u hast subt{ra}yd, whež{er} žou hast wel ydo or no. And že Craft is žis, ryght as ž{o}u subtrayd že než{er} figures fro že hier figures, ry[gh]t so adde že same než{er} figures to že hier figures. And yf ž{o}u haue well y-wroth a-for{e} žou schalt haue že hier nombre že same ž{o}u haddest or žou be-gan to worch. as for žis I bade žou schulde kepe že než{er} figures stylle. lo an [*leaf 145b] Ensampull{e} of all{e} že 4 cases toged{re}. worche well{e} žis case +--------+ |40003468|. |20004664| +--------+ And yf žou worch well{e} whan žou hast all{e} subtrayd že ž{a}t hier nombr{e} her{e}, žis schall{e} be že nombre here foloyng whan ž{o}u hast subtrayd. +--------+ |39998804|. [Sidenote: Our author makes a slip here (3 for 1).] |20004664| +--------+ And žou schalt know ž{us}. adde že než{er} rowe of že same nombre to že hier rewe as žus, cast 4 to 4. žat wol be 8. do away že 4 & write ž{ere} 8. by že first case of addicio[n~]. žan cast 6 to 0 žat wol be 6. do away že 0, & write žere 6. žan cast 6 to 8, ž{a}t wel be 14. do away 8 & write ž{ere} a fig{ur}e of 4, žat is že digit, and write a fig{ur}e of 1. ž{a}t schall be-token ten. ž{a}t is že articul vpon že hed of 8 next aft{er}, žan reken ž{a}t 1. for 1. & cast it to 8. žat schal be 9. cast to žat 9 že než{er} fig{ur}e vnd{er} žat že quych is 4, & žat schall{e} be 13. do away žat 9 & sett ž{er}e 3, & sett a figure of 1. ž{a}t schall be 10 vpon že next figur{is} hede že quych is 9. by že secu{n}de case ž{a}t ž{o}u hadest in addicio[n~]. žan cast 1 to 9. & žat wol be 10. do away že 9. & žat 1. And write ž{ere} a cifer. and write že articull{e} žat is 1. betokenyng{e} 10. vpon že hede of že next figur{e} toward že lyft side, že quych [*leaf 146a] is 9, & so do forth tyl ž{o}u come to že last 9. take že figur{e} of žat 1. že quych ž{o}u schalt fynde ou{er} že hed of 9. & sett it ou{er} že next figures hede žat schal be 3. ¶ Also do away že 9. & set ž{ere} a cifer, & žen cast žat 1 žat stondes vpon že hede of 3 to že same 3, & ž{a}t schall{e} make 4, žen caste to že ylke 4 the figur{e} in že neyž{er} rewe, že quych is 2, and žat schall{e} be 6. And žen schal ž{o}u haue an Ensampull{e} a[gh]ey[n~], loke & se, & but ž{o}u haue žis same ž{o}u hase myse-wro[gh]t. +--------+ |60003468| |20004664| +--------+ Sequit{ur} de duplac{i}one [Headnote: The Craft of Duplation.] ++Si vis duplar{e} num{er}u{m}, sic i{n}cipe p{rim}o Scribe fig{ur}ar{um} serie{m} q{ua}mcu{n}q{ue} vel{is} tu. [Sidenote: Four things must be known in Duplation. Here they are. Mind where you begin. Remember your rules.] ¶ This is the Chaptur{e} of duplacio[n~], in že quych craft ž{o}u most haue & know 4 thing{es}. ¶ Že first ž{a}t ž{o}u most know is what is duplacio[n~]. že secu{n}de is how mony rewes of fig{ur}es ž{o}u most haue to žis craft. ¶ že thryde is how many cases may[{6}] happe in žis craft. ¶ že fourte is what is že p{ro}fet of že craft. ¶ As for že first. duplacio[n~] is a doublyng{e} of a nombre. ¶ As for že secu{n}de ž{o}u most [*leaf 146b] haue on nombre or on rewe of figures, the quych called nu{merus} dupland{us}. As for že thrid ž{o}u most know žat 3 diu{er}se cases may hap in žis craft. As for že fourte. qwat is že p{ro}fet of žis craft, & ž{a}t is to know what a-risy[gh]t of a nombre I-doublyde. ¶ fforž{er}-mor{e}, ž{o}u most know & take gode hede in quych side ž{o}u schall{e} be-gyn in žis craft, or ellis ž{o}u mayst spyl all{e} ž{i} lab{er} ž{er}e aboute. c{er}teyn ž{o}u schalt begy[n~] in the lyft side in žis Craft. thenke wel ou{er} žis verse. ¶ [{7}]A leua dupla, diuide, m{u}ltiplica.[{7}] [[Subt{ra}has a{u}t addis a dext{ri}s {ve}l medi{a}b{is}]] The sentens of žes verses afor{e}, as ž{o}u may see if ž{o}u take hede. As že text of žis verse, žat is to say, ¶ Si vis duplare. žis is že sentence. ¶ If ž{o}u wel double a nombre žus ž{o}u most be-gyn[n~]. Write a rewe of figures of what nomb{re} žou welt. v{er}sus. Postea p{ro}cedas p{ri}ma{m} duplando figura{m} Inde q{uo}d excrescit scribas vbi iusserit ordo Iuxta p{re}cepta tibi que dant{ur} in addic{i}one. [Sidenote: How to work a sum.] ¶ Her{e} he telles how ž{o}u schalt worch in žis Craft. he says, fyrst, whan ž{o}u hast writen že nombre ž{o}u schalt be-gyn at že first figur{e} in the lyft side, & doubull{e} žat fig{ur}e, & že nombre žat comes ž{ere}-of ž{o}u schalt write as ž{o}u diddyst in addicio[n~], as ¶ I schal telle že in že case. v{er}sus. [Headnote: The Cases of the Craft of Duplation.] [*leaf 147a] ¶ Nam si sit digitus in primo limite scribas. [Sidenote: If the answer is a digit, write it in the place of the top figure.] ¶ Her{e} is že first case of žis craft, že quych is žis. yf of duplacio[n~] of a figur{e} arise a digit. what schal ž{o}u do. žus ž{o}u schal do. do away že fig{ur}e žat was doublede, & sett ž{ere} že diget žat comes of že duplacio[n~], as žus. 23. double 2, & ž{a}t wel be 4. do away že figur{e} of 2 & sett ž{ere} a figur{e} of 4, & so worch forth till{e} ž{o}u come to že ende. v{er}sus. ¶ Articul{us} si sit, in p{ri}mo limite cifram, ¶ Articulu{m} v{er}o reliquis inscribe figuris; ¶ Vel p{er} se scribas, si nulla figura sequat{ur}. [Sidenote: If it is an article, put a cipher in the place, and 'carry' the tens. If there is no figure to 'carry' them to, write them down.] ¶ Here is že secunde case, že quych is žis yf ž{ere} come an articull{e} of že duplacio[n~] of a fig{ur}e ž{o}u schalt do ry[gh]t as ž{o}u diddyst in addicio[n~], žat is to wete žat ž{o}u schalt do away že figur{e} žat is doublet & sett ž{ere} a cifer, & write že articull{e} ou{er} že next figur{is} hede, yf ž{ere} be any aft{er}-warde toward že lyft side as žus. 25. begyn at the lyft side, and doubull{e} 2. žat wel be 4. do away žat 2 & sett žere 4. žan doubul 5. žat wel be 10. do away 5, & sett ž{ere} a 0, & sett 1 vpon že next figur{is} hede že quych is 4. & žen draw downe 1 to 4 & žat woll{e} be 5, & žen do away ž{a}t 4 & žat 1, & sett ž{ere} 5. for žat 1 schal be rekened in že drawyng{e} toged{re} for 1. wen [*leaf 147b] žou hast ydon žou schalt haue žis nomb{r}e 50. yf ž{ere} come no figur{e} aft{er} že fig{ur}e ž{a}t is addit, of že quych addicio[n~] comes an articull{e}, ž{o}u schalt do away že figur{e} ž{a}t is dowblet & sett ž{ere} a 0. & write že articul next by in že same rewe toward že lyft syde as žus, 523. double 5 žat woll be ten. do away že figur{e} 5 & set ž{ere} a cifer, & sett že articul next aft{er} in že same rewe toward že lyft side, & žou schalt haue žis nombre 1023. žen go forth & double že ož{er} nombers že quych is ly[gh]t y-now[gh]t to do. v{er}sus. ¶ Compositus si sit, in limite sc{ri}be seq{uen}te Articulu{m}, p{ri}mo digitu{m}; q{uia} sic iubet ordo: Et sic de reliq{ui}s facie{n}s, si sint tibi plures. [Sidenote: If it is a Composite, write down the digit, and 'carry' the tens. Here is an example.] ¶ Her{e} he putt{es} že Thryd case, že quych is žis, yf of duplacio[n~] of a fig{ur}e come a Composit. ž{o}u schalt do away že fig{u}re ž{a}t is doublet & set ž{ere} a digit of že Composit, & sett že articull{e} ou{er} že next figures hede, & aft{er} draw hym downe w{i}t{h} že figur{e} ou{er} whos hede he stondes, & make ž{ere}-of an nombre as ž{o}u hast done afore, & yf ž{ere} come no fig{ur}e aft{er} žat digit žat ž{o}u hast y-write, ža{n} set že articull{e} next aft{er} hym in že same rewe as žus, 67: double 6 žat wel be 12, do away 6 & write ž{ere} že digit [*leaf 148a] of 12, že quych is 2, and set že articull{e} next aft{er} toward že lyft side in že same rewe, for ž{ere} comes no figur{e} aft{er}. žan dowble žat ož{er} figur{e}, že quych is 7, žat wel be 14. the quych is a Composit. žen do away 7 žat ž{o}u doublet & sett že že diget of hy{m}, the quych is 4, sett že articull{e} ou{er} že next figur{es} hed, že quych is 2, & žen draw to hym žat on, & make on nombre že quych schall{e} be 3. And žen yf ž{o}u haue wel y-do ž{o}u schall{e} haue žis nombre of že duplacio[n~], 134. v{er}sus. ¶ Si super ext{re}ma{m} nota sit monade{m} dat eid{em} Quod t{ibi} {con}tingat si p{ri}mo dimidiabis. [Sidenote: How to double the mark for one-half. This can only stand over the first figure.] ¶ Her{e} he says, yf ou{er} že fyrst fig{ur}e in že ry[gh]t side be such a merke as is her{e} made, ^w, ž{o}u schall{e} fyrst doubull{e} že figur{e}, the quych stondes vnd{er} ž{a}t merke, & žen žou schalt doubul žat merke že quych stond{es} for haluendel on. for too haluedels makes on, & so ž{a}t wol be on. cast ž{a}t on to žat duplacio[n~] of že figur{e} ou{er} whos hed stode žat merke, & write it in že same place ž{ere} žat že figur{e} že quych was doublet stode, as žus 23^w. double 3, žat wol be 6; doubul žat halue on, & žat wol be on. cast on to 6, ž{a}t wel be 7. do away 6 & žat 1, & sett ž{ere} 7. žan hase žou do. as for žat figur{e}, žan go [*leaf 148b] to že ož{er} fig{ure} & worch forth. & ž{o}u schall neu{er} haue such a merk but ou{er} že hed of že furst figure in že ryght side. And [gh]et it schal not happe but yf it were y-halued a-for{e}, žus ž{o}u schalt vnd{er}stonde že verse. ¶ Si sup{er} ext{re}ma{m} &c. Et nota, talis fig{ur}a ^w significans medietate{m}, unitat{is} veniat, {i.e.} contingat u{e}l fiat sup{er} ext{re}ma{m}, {i.e.} sup{er} p{ri}ma{m} figura{m} in ext{re}mo sic v{er}sus dextram ars dat: {i.e.} reddit monade{m}. {i.e.} vnitate{m} eide{m}. {i.e.} eidem note & declina{tur} hec monos, d{i}s, di, dem, &c. ¶ Quod {er}g{o} to{tum} ho{c} dabis monade{m} note {con}ting{et}. {i.e.} eveniet tibi si dimidiasti, {i.e.} accipisti u{e}l subtulisti medietatem alicuius unius, in cuius principio sint figura nu{mer}u{m} denotans i{m}pare{m} p{rim}o {i.e.} principiis. [Headnote: The Craft of Mediation.] ¶ Sequit{ur} de mediacione. ++Incipe sic, si vis alique{m} nu{me}ru{m} mediar{e}: Sc{ri}be figurar{um} seriem sola{m}, velut an{te}. [Sidenote: The four things to be known in mediation: the first the second; the third; the fourth. Begin thus.] ¶ In žis Chapter is ta[gh]t že Craft of mediaciou[n~], in že quych craft ž{o}u most know 4 thynges. ffurst what is mediacio[n~]. the secunde how mony rewes of figur{es} ž{o}u most haue in že wyrchyng{e} of žis craft. že thryde how mony diu{er}se cases may happ in žis craft.[{8}] [[the .4. what is že p{ro}fet of žis craft.]] ¶ As for že furst, ž{o}u schalt vndurstonde žat mediacio[n~] is a takyng out of halfe a nomber out of a holle nomber, [*leaf 149a] as yf ž{o}u wolde take 3 out of 6. ¶ As for že secunde, ž{o}u schalt know ž{a}t ž{o}u most haue on{e} rewe of figures, & no moo, as ž{o}u hayst in že craft of duplacio[n~]. ¶ As for the thryd, žou most vnd{er}stonde žat 5 cases may happe in žis craft. ¶ As for že fourte, žou schall{e} know žat the p{ro}fet of žis craft is when ž{o}u hast take away že haluendel of a nomb{re} to telle qwat žer{e} schall{e} leue. ¶ Incipe sic, &c. The sentence of žis verse is žis. yf ž{o}u wold medye, žat is to say, take halfe out of že holle, or halfe out of halfe, žou most begynne ž{us}. Write on{e} rewe of figur{es} of what nombre žou wolte, as ž{o}u dyddyst be-for{e} in že Craft of duplacio[n~]. v{er}sus. ¶ Postea p{ro}cedas medians, si p{ri}ma figura Si par aut i{m}par videas. [Sidenote: See if the number is even or odd.] ¶ Her{e} he says, when ž{o}u hast write a rewe of figures, ž{o}u schalt take hede whež{er} že first figur{e} be eue[n~] or odde in nombre, & vnd{er}stonde ž{a}t he spekes of že first figure in že ry[gh]t side. And i{n} the ryght side ž{o}u schall{e} begynne in žis Craft. ¶ Quia si fu{er}it par, Dimidiab{is} eam, scribe{n}s quicq{ui}d remanebit: [Sidenote: If it is even, halve it, and write the answer in its place.] ¶ Her{e} is the first case of žis craft, že quych is žis, yf že first figur{e} be euen. žou schal take away fro že figur{e} euen halfe, & do away žat fig{ur}e and set ž{ere} žat leues ou{er}, as žus, 4. take [*leaf 149b] halfe out of 4, & žan ž{ere} leues 2. do away 4 & sett ž{ere} 2. žis is lyght y-now[gh]t. v{er}sus. [Headnote: The Mediation of an Odd Number.] ¶ Impar si fu{er}it vnu{m} demas mediar{e} Quod no{n} p{re}sumas, s{ed} quod sup{er}est mediabis Inde sup{er} tractu{m} fac demptu{m} quod no{ta}t vnu{m}. [Sidenote: If it is odd, halve the even number less than it. Here is an example. Then write the sign for one-half over it. Put the mark only over the first figure.] Her{e} is že secunde case of žis craft, the quych is žis. yf že first figur{e} betoken{e} a nombre žat is odde, the quych odde schal not be mediete, žen ž{o}u schalt medye žat nombre žat leues, when the odde of že same nomb{re} is take away, & write žat ž{a}t leues as ž{o}u diddest in že first case of žis craft. Wha[n~] ž{o}u hayst write žat. for ž{a}t žat leues, write such a merke as is her{e} ^w vpon his hede, že quych merke schal betoke[n~] halfe of že odde žat was take away. lo an Ensampull. 245. the first figur{e} her{e} is betokenyng{e} odde nombre, že quych is 5, for 5 is odde; ž{er}e-for{e} do away žat ž{a}t is odde, že quych is 1. žen leues 4. žen medye 4 & žen leues 2. do away 4. & sette ž{ere} 2, & make such a merke ^w upon his hede, žat is to say ou{er} his hede of 2 as žus. 242.^w And žen worch forth in že ož{er} figures tyll ž{o}u come to že ende. by že furst case as ž{o}u schalt vnd{er}stonde žat ž{o}u schalt [*leaf 150a] neu{er} make such a merk but ou{er} že first fig{ur}e hed in že ri[gh]t side. Whež{er} že other fig{ur}es žat comy[n~] aft{er} hym be eue[n~] or odde. v{er}sus. [Headnote: The Cases of the Craft of Mediation.] ¶ Si monos, dele; sit t{ibi} cifra post no{ta} supra. [Sidenote: If the first figure is one put a cipher.] ¶ Here is že thryde case, že quych yf the first figur{e} be a figur{e} of 1. ž{o}u schalt do away žat 1 & set ž{ere} a cifer, & a merke ou{er} že cifer as žus, 241. do away 1, & sett ž{ere} a cifer w{i}t{h} a merke ou{er} his hede, & žen hast ž{o}u ydo for žat 0. as žus 0^w žen worch forth in že ožer fig{ur}ys till ž{o}u come to že ende, for it is lyght as dyche water. vn{de} v{er}sus. ¶ Postea p{ro}cedas hac condic{i}one secu{n}da: Imp{ar} si fu{er}it hinc vnu{m} deme p{ri}ori, Inscribens quinque, nam denos significabit Monos p{re}d{ict}am. [Sidenote: What to do if any other figure is odd. Write a figure of five over the next lower number's head. Example.] ¶ Her{e} he putt{es} že fourte case, že quych is žis. yf it happe[n~] the secunde figur{e} betoken odde nombre, žou schal do away on of žat odde nombre, že quych is significatiue by ž{a}t figure 1. že quych 1 schall be rekende for 10. Whan ž{o}u hast take away ž{a}t 1 out of že nombre ž{a}t is signifiede by žat figur{e}, ž{o}u schalt medie ž{a}t žat leues ou{er}, & do away žat figur{e} žat is medied, & sette in his styde halfe of ž{a}t nombre. ¶ Whan ž{o}u hase so done, ž{o}u schalt write [*leaf 150b] a figure of 5 ou{er} že next figur{es} hede by-for{e} toward že ry[gh]t side, for žat 1, že quych made odd nombr{e}, schall stonde for ten, & 5 is halfe of 10; so ž{o}u most write 5 for his haluendell{e}. lo an Ensampull{e}, 4678. begy[n~] in že ry[gh]t side as ž{o}u most nedes. medie 8. žen ž{o}u schalt leue 4. do away žat 8 & sette ž{ere} 4. žen out of 7. take away 1. že quych makes odde, & sett 5. vpon že next figur{es} hede afor{e} toward že ry[gh]t side, že quych is now 4. but afor{e} it was 8. for žat 1 schal be rekenet for 10, of že quych 10, 5 is halfe, as žou knowest wel. Whan ž{o}u hast žus ydo, medye ž{a}t že quych leues aft{er} že takying{e} away of žat žat is odde, že quych leuyng{e} schall{e} be 3; do away 6 & sette ž{er}e 3, & žou schalt haue such a nombre 5 4634. aft{er} go forth to že next fig{ur}e, & medy žat, & worch forth, for it is ly[gh]t ynov[gh]t to že c{er}tay[n~]. ¶ Si v{er}o s{e}c{un}da dat vnu{m}. Illa deleta, sc{ri}bat{ur} cifra; p{ri}ori ¶ Tradendo quinque pro denario mediato; Nec cifra sc{ri}batur, nisi dei{n}de fig{ur}a seq{u}at{ur}: Postea p{ro}cedas reliq{ua}s mediando figuras Vt sup{ra} docui, si sint tibi mille figure. [Sidenote: If the second figure is one, put a cipher, and write five over the next figure. How to halve fourteen.] ¶ Her{e} he putt{es} že 5 case, že quych is [*leaf 151a] žis: yf že secunde figur{e} be of 1, as žis is here 12, žou schalt do away žat 1 & sett ž{ere} a cifer. & sett 5 ou{er} že next fig{ur}e hede afor{e} toward že ri[gh]t side, as žou diddyst afor{e}; & žat 5 schal be haldel of žat 1, že quych 1 is rekent for 10. lo an Ensampull{e}, 214. medye 4. ž{a}t schall{e} be 2. do away 4 & sett ž{ere} 2. že{n} go forth to že next figur{e}. že quych is bot 1. do away žat 1. & sett ž{ere} a cifer. & set 5 vpon že figur{es} hed afor{e}, že quych is nowe 2, & žen žou schalt haue žis no{m}b{re} 5 202, žen worch forth to že nex fig{ur}e. And also it is no mayst{er}y yf ž{ere} come no figur{e} after žat on is medyet, ž{o}u schalt write no 0. ne now[gh]t ellis, but set 5 ou{er} že next fig{ur}e afor{e} toward že ry[gh]t, as žus 14. medie 4 then leues 2, do away 4 & sett ž{ere} 2. žen medie 1. že q{ui}ch is rekende for ten, že halue{n}del ž{ere}-of wel be 5. sett ž{a}t 5 vpon že hede of ž{a}t figur{e}, že quych is now 2, & do away ž{a}t 1, & žou schalt haue žis nombre yf ž{o}u worch wel, 5  2. vn{de} v{er}sus. [Headnote: How to prove the Mediation.] ¶ Si mediacio sit b{e}n{e} f{ac}ta p{ro}bar{e} valeb{is} ¶ Duplando num{er}u{m} que{m} p{ri}mo di{m}ediasti [Sidenote: How to prove your mediation. First example. The second. The third example. The fourth example. The fifth example.] ¶ Her{e} he telles že how žou schalt know whež{er} žou hase wel ydo or no. doubul [*leaf 151b] že nombre že quych ž{o}u hase mediet, and yf ž{o}u haue wel y-medyt after že dupleacio[n~], žou schalt haue že same nombre žat ž{o}u haddyst in že tabull{e} or ž{o}u began to medye, as žus. ¶ The furst ensampull{e} was žis. 4. že quych I-mediet was laft 2, že whych 2 was write in že place ž{a}t 4 was write afor{e}. Now doubull{e} žat 2, & ž{o}u schal haue 4, as ž{o}u hadyst afor{e}. že secunde Ensampull{e} was žis, 245. When ž{o}u haddyst mediet all{e} žis nomb{re}, yf žou haue wel ydo žou schalt haue of ž{a}t mediacio[n~] žis nombre, 122^w. Now doubull{e} žis nombre, & begyn in že lyft side; doubull{e} 1, žat schal be 2. do away žat 1 & sett ž{ere} 2. žen doubull{e} ž{a}t ož{er} 2 & sett ž{ere} 4, žen doubull{e} žat ož{er} 2, & žat wel be 4. že{n} doubul žat merke žat stondes for halue on. & žat schall{e} be 1. Cast žat on to 4, & it schall{e} be 5. do away žat 2 & žat merke, & sette ž{ere} 5, & žen ž{o}u schal haue žis nombre 245. & žis wos že same nombur ž{a}t ž{o}u haddyst or ž{o}u began to medye, as ž{o}u mayst se yf žou take hede. The nombre že quych žou haddist for an Ensampul in že 3 case of mediacio[n~] to be mediet was žis 241. whan ž{o}u haddist medied all{e} žis nombur truly [*leaf 152a] by eu{er}y figur{e}, žou schall haue be ž{a}t mediacio[n~] žis nombur 120^w. Now dowbul žis nomb{ur}, & begyn in že lyft side, as I tolde že in že Craft of duplacio[n~]. žus doubull{e} že fig{ur}e of 1, žat wel be 2. do away žat 1 & sett ž{ere} 2, žen doubul že next figur{e} afore, the quych is 2, & žat wel be 4; do away 2 & set ž{ere} 4. žen doubul že cifer, & žat wel be no[gh]t, for a 0 is no[gh]t. And twyes no[gh]t is but no[gh]t. ž{ere}for{e} doubul the merke aboue že cifers hede, že quych betokenes že halue{n}del of 1, & žat schal be 1. do away že cifer & že merke, & sett ž{ere} 1, & žen ž{o}u schalt haue žis nombur 241. And žis same nombur ž{o}u haddyst afore or ž{o}u began to medy, & yf ž{o}u take gode hede. ¶ The next ensampul žat had in že 4 case of mediacio[n~] was žis 4678. Whan ž{o}u hast truly ymedit all{e} žis nombur fro že begynnyng{e} to že endyng{e}, ž{o}u schalt haue of že mediacio[n~] žis nombur 5 2334. Now doubul this nombur & begyn in že lyft side, & doubull{e} 2 žat schal be 4. do away 2 and sette žere 4; žen doubul{e} 3, ž{a}t wol be 6; do away 3 & sett ž{ere} 6, žen doubul žat ož{er} 3, & žat wel be 6; do away 3 & set ž{ere} [*leaf 152b] 6, žen doubul že 4, žat welle be 8; žen doubul 5. že quych stondes ou{er} že hed of 4, & žat wol be 10; cast 10 to 8, & ž{a}t schal be 18; do away 4 & žat 5, & sett ž{ere} 8, & sett that 1, že quych is an articul of že Composit že quych is 18, ou{er} že next figur{es} hed toward že lyft side, že quych is 6. drav ž{a}t 1 to 6, že quych 1 in že dravyng schal be rekente bot for 1, & ž{a}t 1 & ž{a}t 6 togedur wel be 7. do away žat 6 & žat 1. the quych stondes ou{er} his hede, & sett ther 7, & žen žou schalt haue žis nombur 4678. And žis same nombur ž{o}u hadyst or ž{o}u began to medye, as ž{o}u mayst see in že secunde Ensampul žat žou had in že 4 case of mediacio[n~], žat was žis: when ž{o}u had mediet truly all{e} the nombur, a p{ri}ncipio usque ad fine{m}. ž{o}u schalt haue of žat mediacio[n~] žis nombur 5 102. Now doubul 1. žat wel be 2. do away 1 & sett ž{ere} 2. žen doubul 0. ž{a}t will be no[gh]t. ž{ere}for{e} take že 5, že quych stondes ou{er} že next figur{es} hed, & doubul it, & žat wol be 10. do away že 0 žat stondes betwene že two fig{u}r{i}s, & sette ž{ere} in his stid 1, for ž{a}t 1 now schal stonde in že secunde place, wher{e} he schal betoken 10; žen doubul 2, žat wol be 4. do away 2 & sett žere 4. & [*leaf 153a] žou schal haue žus nombur 214. žis is že same nu{m}bur žat ž{o}u hadyst or ž{o}u began to medye, as ž{o}u may see. And so do eu{er} mor{e}, yf ž{o}u wil knowe whež{er} žou hase wel ymedyt or no. ¶. doubull{e} že nu{m}bur žat comes aft{er} že mediaciou[n~], & ž{o}u schal haue že same nombur ž{a}t ž{o}u hadyst or ž{o}u began to medye, yf ž{o}u haue welle ydo. or els doute že no[gh]t, but yf ž{o}u haue že same, ž{o}u hase faylide in ž{i} Craft. +Sequitur de multiplicatione.+ [Headnote: The Craft of Multiplication.] [Headnote: To write down a Multiplication Sum.] ++Si tu p{er} num{er}u{m} num{er}u{m} vis m{u}ltiplicar{e} Scribe duas q{ua}scu{nque} velis series nu{me}ror{um} Ordo s{er}vet{ur} vt vltima m{u}ltiplicandi Ponat{ur} sup{er} ant{er}iorem multiplicant{is} A leua reliq{u}e sint scripte m{u}ltiplicantes. [Sidenote: Four things to be known of Multiplication: the first: the second: the third: the fourth. How to set down the sum. Two sorts of Multiplication: mentally, and on paper.] ¶ Her{e} be-gynnes že Chapt{r}e of m{u}ltiplicatio[n~], in že quych žou most know 4 thynges. ¶ Ffirst, qwat is m{u}ltiplicacio[n~]. The secunde, how mony cases may hap in multiplicacio[n~]. The thryde, how mony rewes of figur{es} ž{ere} most be. ¶ The 4. what is že p{ro}fet of žis craft. ¶ As for že first, ž{o}u schal vnd{er}stonde žat m{u}ltiplicacio[n~] is a bryngyng{e} to-ged{er} of 2 thyng{es} in on nombur, že quych on nombur {con}tynes so mony tymes on, howe [*leaf 153b] mony tymes ž{ere} ben vnytees in že nowmb{re} of žat 2, as twyes 4 is 8. now her{e} ben že 2 nomb{er}s, of že quych too nowmbr{e}s on is betokened be an adu{er}be, že quych is že worde twyes, & žis worde thryes, & žis worde four{e} sythes,[{9}] [[& žis wordes fyue sithe & sex sythes.]] & so furth of such other lyke wordes. ¶ And tweyn nombres schal be tokenyde be a nowne, as žis worde four{e} showys žes twey[n~] nombres y-broth in-to on hole nombur, žat is 8, for twyes 4 is 8, as ž{o}u wost wel. ¶ And žes nomb{re} 8 conteynes as oft tymes 4 as ž{ere} ben vnites in ž{a}t other nomb{re}, že quych is 2, for in 2 ben 2 vnites, & so oft tymes 4 ben in 8, as ž{o}u wottys wel. ¶ ffor že secu{n}de, ž{o}u most know žat ž{o}u most haue too rewes of figures. ¶ As for že thryde, ž{o}u most know ž{a}t 8 man{er} of diu{er}se case may happe in žis craft. The p{ro}fet of žis Craft is to telle when a nomb{re} is m{u}ltiplyed be a nož{er}, qwat co{m}mys ž{ere} of. ¶ fforthermor{e}, as to že sentence of our{e} verse, yf ž{o}u wel m{u}ltiply a nombur be a-nož{er} nomb{ur}, žou schalt write [*leaf 154a] a rewe of figures of what nomb{ur}s so eu{er} ž{o}u welt, & žat schal be called Num{erus} m{u}ltiplicand{us}, Anglice, že nomb{ur} the quych to be m{u}ltiplied. žen ž{o}u schalt write a-nother rewe of figur{e}s, by že quych ž{o}u schalt m{u}ltiplie the nombre žat is to be m{u}ltiplied, of že quych nomb{ur} že furst fig{ur}e schal be write vnd{er} že last figur{e} of že nomb{ur}, že quych is to be m{u}ltiplied. And so write forthe toward že lyft side, as her{e} you may se, +----------+ | 67324 | | 1234 | +----------+ And žis on{e} nomb{ur} schall{e} be called nu{meru}s m{u}ltiplicans. An{gli}ce, že nomb{ur} m{u}ltipliyng{e}, for he schall{e} m{u}ltiply že hyer nounb{ur}, as žus on{e} tyme 6. And so forth, as I schal telle the aft{er}warde. And žou schal begyn in že lyft side. ¶ ffor-ž{ere}-more žou schalt vndurstonde žat ž{ere} is two man{ur}s of m{u}ltiplicacio[n~]; one ys of že wyrchyng{e} of že boke only in že mynde of a mon. fyrst he teches of že fyrst man{er} of duplacio[n~], že quych is be wyrchyng{e} of tabuls. Aft{er}warde he wol teche on že secunde man{er}. vn{de} v{er}sus. [Headnote: To multiply one Digit by another.] In digitu{m} cures digitu{m} si duc{er}e ma{i}or [*leaf 154b.] P{er} qua{n}tu{m} distat a denis respice debes ¶ Namq{ue} suo decuplo totiens deler{e} mi{n}ore{m} Sitq{ue} tibi nu{meru}s veniens exinde patebit. [Sidenote: How to multiply two digits. Subtract the greater from ten; take the less so many times from ten times itself. Example.] ¶ Her{e} he teches a rewle, how ž{o}u schalt fynde že nounb{r}e žat comes by že m{u}ltiplicacio[n~] of a digit be anož{er}. loke how mony [vny]tes ben. bytwene že mor{e} digit and 10. And reken ten for on vnite. And so oft do away že lasse nounbre out of his owne decuple, žat is to say, fro žat nounb{r}e žat is ten tymes so mych is že nounb{re} ž{a}t comes of že m{u}ltiplicacio[n~]. As yf ž{o}u wol m{u}ltiply 2 be 4. loke how mony vnitees ben by-twene že quych is že mor{e} nounb{re}, & be-twene ten. C{er}ten ž{ere} wel be vj vnitees by-twene 4 & ten. yf ž{o}u reken ž{ere} w{i}t{h} že ten že vnite, as žou may se. so mony tymes take 2. out of his decuple, že quych is 20. for 20 is že decuple of 2, 10 is že decuple of 1, 30 is že decuple of 3, 40 is že decuple of 4, And že ož{er} digetes til ž{o}u come to ten; & whan ž{o}u hast y-take so mony tymes 2 out of twenty, že quych is sex tymes, ž{o}u schal leue 8 as ž{o}u wost wel, for 6 times 2 is twelue. take [1]2 out of twenty, & ž{ere} schal leue 8. bot yf bothe že digett{es} [*leaf 155a] ben y-lyech mych as her{e}. 222 or too tymes twenty, žen it is no fors quych of hem tweyn ž{o}u take out of here decuple. als mony tymes as ž{a}t is fro 10. but neu{er}-že-lesse, yf ž{o}u haue hast to worch, ž{o}u schalt haue her{e} a tabul of figures, wher{e}-by ž{o}u schalt se a-non[n~] ryght what is že nounbre ž{a}t comes of že multiplicacio[n~] of 2 digittes. žus ž{o}u schalt worch in žis fig{ur}e. [Sidenote: Better use this table, though. How to use it. The way to use the Multiplication table.] 1| ----- 2| 4| -------- 3| 6| 9| ----------- 4| 8|12|16| -------------- 5|10|15|20|25| ----------------- 6|12|18|24|30|36| -------------------- 7|14|21|28|35|42|49| ----------------------- 8|16|24|32|40|48|56|64| -------------------------- 9|18|27|36|45|54|63|72|81| ---------------------------- 1| 2| 3| 4| 5| 6| 7| 8| 9| ---------------------------- yf že fig{ur}e, že quych schall{e} be m{u}ltiplied, be euen{e} as mych as že diget be, že quych žat ož{er} figur{e} schal be m{u}ltiplied, as two tymes tway[n~], or thre tymes 3. or sych other. loke qwer{e} žat fig{ur}e sittes in že lyft side of že t{ri}angle, & loke qwer{e} že diget sittes in že než{er} most rewe of že triangle. & go fro hym vpwarde in že same rewe, že quych rewe gose vpwarde til ž{o}u come agaynes že ož{er} digette žat sittes in že lyft side of že t{ri}angle. And žat nounbre, že quych žou [*leaf 155b] fyn[*]des ž{ere} is že nounbre žat comes of the m{u}ltiplicacio[n~] of že 2 digittes, as yf žou wold wete qwat is 2 tymes 2. loke quer{e} sittes 2 in že lyft side i{n} že first rewe, he sittes next 1 in že lyft side al on hye, as ž{o}u may se; že[{n}] loke qwer{e} sittes 2 in že lowyst rewe of že t{ri}angle, & go fro hym vpwarde in že same rewe tyll{e} žou come a-[gh]enenes 2 in že hyer place, & žer žou schalt fynd ywrite 4, & žat is že nounb{r}e žat comes of že multiplicacio[n~] of two tymes tweyn is 4, as žow wotest well{e}. yf že diget. the quych is m{u}ltiplied, be mor{e} žan že ož{er}, žou schalt loke qwer{e} že mor{e} diget sittes in že lowest rewe of že t{ri}angle, & go vpwarde in že same rewe tyl[{10}] ž{o}u come a-nendes že lasse diget in the lyft side. And ž{ere} ž{o}u schalt fynde že no{m}b{r}e žat comes of že m{u}ltiplicacio[n~]; but ž{o}u schalt vnd{er}stonde žat žis rewle, že quych is in žis v{er}se. ¶ In digitu{m} cures, &c., nož{er} žis t{ri}angle schall{e} not s{er}ue, bot to fynde že nounbres ž{a}t comes of the m{u}ltiplicacio[n~] žat comes of 2 articuls or {com}posites, že nedes no craft but yf žou wolt m{u}ltiply in ži mynde. And [*leaf 156a] žere-to žou schalt haue a craft aft{er}warde, for žou schall wyrch w{i}t{h} digettes in že tables, as žou schalt know aft{er}warde. v{er}sus. [Headnote: To multiply one Composite by another.] ¶ Postea p{ro}cedas postrema{m} m{u}ltiplica{n}do [Recte multiplicans per cu{n}ctas i{n}feriores] Condic{i}onem tamen t{a}li q{uod} m{u}ltiplicant{es} Scribas in capite quicq{ui}d p{ro}cesserit inde Sed postq{uam} fuit hec m{u}ltiplicate fig{ur}e Anteriorent{ur} serei m{u}ltiplica{n}t{is} Et sic m{u}ltiplica velut isti m{u}ltiplicasti Qui sequit{ur} nu{mer}u{m} sc{ri}ptu{m} quiscu{n}q{ue} figur{is}. [Sidenote: How to multiply one number by another. Multiply the 'last' figure of the higher by the 'first' of the lower number. Set the answer over the first of the lower: then multiply the second of the lower, and so on. Then antery the lower number: as thus. Now multiply by the last but one of the higher: as thus. Antery the figures again, and multiply by five: Then add all the figures above the line: and you will have the answer.] ¶ Her{e} he teches how ž{o}u schalt wyrch in žis craft. žou schalt m{ul}tiplye že last figur{e} of že nombre, and quen ž{o}u hast so ydo žou schalt draw all{e} že figures of že než{er} nounbre mor{e} taward že ry[gh]t side, so qwe{n} ž{o}u hast m{u}ltiplyed že last figur{e} of že heyer nounbre by all{e} že než{er} figures. And sette že nounbir žat comes žer-of ou{er} že last figur{e} of že než{er} nounb{re}, & žen žou schalt sette al že ož{er} fig{ur}es of že než{er} nounb{re} mor{e} ner{e} to že ry[gh]t side. ¶ And whan žou hast m{u}ltiplied žat figur{e} žat schal be m{u}ltiplied že next aft{er} hym by al že než{er} figures. And worch as žou dyddyst afor{e} til [*leaf 156b] žou come to že ende. And žou schalt vnd{er}stonde žat eu{er}y figur{e} of že hier nounb{re} schal be m{u}ltiplied be all{e} že figur{e}s of the než{er} nounbre, yf že hier nounb{re} be any figur{e} žen on{e}. lo an Ensampul her{e} folowyng{e}. +------+ | 2465|. |232 | +------+ žou schalt begyne to m{u}ltiplye in že lyft side. M{u}ltiply 2 be 2, and twyes 2 is 4. set 4 ou{er} že hed of ž{a}t 2, žen m{u}ltiplie že same hier 2 by 3 of že nether nounbre, as thryes 2 žat schal be 6. set 6 ou{er} že hed of 3, žan m{u}ltiplie že same hier 2 by žat 2 že quych stondes vnd{er} hym, ž{a}t wol be 4; do away že hier 2 & sette ž{ere} 4. ¶ Now ž{o}u most antery že nether nounbre, žat is to say, ž{o}u most sett že než{er} nounbre more towarde že ry[gh]t side, as žus. Take že než{er} 2 toward že ry[gh]t side, & sette it eue[n~] vnd{er} že 4 of že hyer nounb{r}e, & ant{er}y all{e} že figures žat comes aft{er} žat 2, as žus; sette 2 vnd{er} že 4. žen sett že figur{e} of 3 ž{ere} žat že figure of 2 stode, že quych is now vndur ž{a}t 4 in že hier nounbre; žen sett že ožer figur{e} of 2, že quych is že last fig{ur}e toward že lyft side of že než{er} nomb{er} ž{ere} že figur{e} of 3 stode. žen ž{o}u schalt haue such a nombre. +------+ |464465| | 232 | +------+ [*leaf 157a] ¶ Now m{u}ltiply 4, že quych comes next aft{er} 6, by že last 2 of že než{er} nounbur toward že lyft side. as 2 tymes 4, žat wel be 8. sette žat 8 ou{er} že figure the quych stondes ou{er} že hede of žat 2, že quych is že last figur{e} of že než{er} nounbre; žan multiplie žat same 4 by 3, žat comes in že než{er} rewe, žat wol be 12. sette že digit of že composyt ou{er} že figure že quych stondes ou{er} že hed of žat 3, & sette že articule of žis co{m}posit ou{er} al že figures žat stondes ou{er} že než{er} 2 hede. žen m{u}ltiplie že same 4 by že 2 in že ry[gh]t side in že než{er} nounbur, žat wol be 8. do away 4. & sette ž{ere} 8. Eu{er} mor{e} qwen ž{o}u m{u}ltiplies že hier figur{e} by žat figur{e} že quych stondes vnd{er} hym, žou schalt do away žat hier figur{e}, & sett žer žat nounbre že quych comes of m{u}ltiplicacio[n~] of ylke digittes. Whan žou hast done as I haue byde že, ž{o}u schalt haue suych an ord{er} of figur{e} as is her{e}, +--------+ | 1 |. | 82 | |4648[65]| | 232 | +--------+ žen take and ant{er}y ži než{er} figures. And sett že fyrst fig{ur}e of že než{er} figures[{11}] vndre be figur{e} of 6. ¶ And draw al že ož{er} figures of že same rewe to hym-warde, [*leaf 157b] as ž{o}u diddyst afore. žen m{u}ltiplye 6 be 2, & sett žat že quych comes ou{er} ž{ere}-of ou{er} al že ož{er} figures hedes žat stondes ou{er} žat 2. žen m{u}ltiply 6 be 3, & sett all{e} žat comes ž{ere}-of vpon all{e} že figur{e}s hedes žat standes ou{er} žat 3; ža{n} m{u}ltiplye 6 be 2, že quych stondes vnd{er} žat 6, žen do away 6 & write ž{ere} že digitt of že composit žat schal come ž{ere}of, & sette že articull ou{er} all{e} že figures žat stondes ou{er} že hede of žat 3 as her{e}, +------+ | 11 | | 121 | | 828 | |464825| | 232 | +------+ žen ant{er}y ži figures as žou diddyst afor{e}, and m{u}ltipli 5 be 2, žat wol be 10; sett že 0 ou{er} all že figures ž{a}t stonden ou{er} žat 2, & sett ž{a}t 1. ou{er} the next figures hedes, all{e} on hye towarde že lyft side. žen m{u}ltiplye 5 be 3. žat wol be 15, write 5 ou{er} že figures hedes žat stonden ou{er} ž{a}t 3, & sett žat 1 ou{er} že next figur{e}s hedes toward že lyft side. žen m{u}ltiplye 5 be 2, žat wol be 10. do away žat 5 & sett ž{ere} a 0, & sett žat 1 ou{er} že figures hedes žat stonden ou{er} 3. And žen žou schalt haue such a nounbre as here stondes aftur.[*leaf 158a] +------+ | 11 | | 1101 | | 1215 | | 82820| |4648 | | 232| +------+ ¶ Now draw all{e} žese figures downe toged{er} as žus, 6.8.1. & 1 draw to-gedur; žat wolle be 16, do away all{e} žese figures saue 6. lat hym stonde, for žow ž{o}u take hym away žou most write žer že same a[gh]ene. ž{ere}for{e} late hym stonde, & sett 1 ou{er} že figur{e} hede of 4 toward že lyft side; žen draw on to 4, žat woll{e} be 5. do away žat 4 & žat 1, & sette ž{ere} 5. žen draw 4221 & 1 toged{ur}, žat wol be 10. do away all{e} žat, & write žere žat 4 & žat 0, & sett žat 1 ou{er} že next figur{es} hede toward že lyft side, že quych is 6. žen draw žat 6 & žat 1 togedur, & žat wolle be 7; do away 6 & sett ž{ere} 7, žen draw 8810 & 1, & žat wel be 18; do away all{e} že figures ž{a}t stondes ou{er} že hede of žat 8, & lette 8 stonde stil, & write žat 1 ou{er} že next fig{u}r{is} hede, že quych is a 0. žen do away žat 0, & sett ž{ere} 1, že quych stondes ou{er} že 0. hede. žen draw 2, 5, & 1 toged{ur}, žat woll{e} be 8. žen do away all{e} žat, & write ž{ere} 8. ¶ And žen žou schalt haue žis nounbre, 571880. [Headnote: The Cases of this Craft.] [*leaf 158b] ¶ S{ed} cu{m} m{u}ltiplicabis, p{ri}mo sic e{st} op{er}andu{m}, Si dabit articulu{m} tibi m{u}ltiplicacio solu{m}; P{ro}posita cifra su{m}ma{m} t{ra}nsferre meme{n}to. [Sidenote: What to do if the first multiplication results in an article.] ¶ Her{e} he puttes že fyrst case of žis craft, že quych is žis: yf ž{ere} come an articulle of že m{u}ltiplicacio[n~] ysette befor{e} the articull{e} in že lyft side as žus +---+ | 51|. |23 | +---+ multiplye 5 by 2, žat wol be 10; sette ou{er} že hede of žat 2 a 0, & sett žat on, žat is že articul, in že lyft side, žat is next hym, žen ž{o}u schalt haue žis nounbre +----+ |1051|. | 23 | +----+ ¶ And žen worch forth as žou diddist afore. And ž{o}u schalt vnd{er}stonde žat ž{o}u schalt write no 0. but whan žat place where žou schal write žat 0 has no figure afore hy{m} nož{er} aft{er}. v{er}sus. ¶ Si aut{em} digitus excreu{er}it articul{us}q{ue}. Articul{us}[{12}] sup{ra}p{osit}o digito salit vltra. [Sidenote: What to do if the result is a composite number.] ¶ Her{e} is že secunde case, že quych is žis: yf hit happe žat ž{ere} come a composyt, žou schalt write že digitte ou{er} že hede of že než{er} figur{e} by že quych ž{o}u multipliest že hier figure; and sett že articull{e} next hym toward že lyft side, as žou diddyst afore, as ž{us} +---+ | 83|. |83 | +---+ Multiply 8 by 8, žat wol be 64. Write že 4 ou{er} 8, žat is to say, ou{er} že hede of že než{er} 8; & set 6, že quych [*leaf 159a] is an articul, next aft{er}. And žen žou schalt haue such a nounb{r}e as is her{e}, +-----------+ | 6483[{13}]|, | 83 | +-----------+ And žen worch forth. ¶ Si digitus t{amen} ponas ip{su}m sup{er} ip{s}am. [Sidenote: What if it be a digit.] ¶ Her{e} is že thryde case, že quych is žis: yf hit happe žat of ži m{u}ltiplicaciou[n~] come a digit, ž{o}u schalt write že digit ou{er} že hede of že než{er} figur{e}, by the quych žou m{u}ltipliest že hier{e} figur{e}, for žis nedes no Ensampul. ¶ Subdita m{u}ltiplica non hanc que [incidit] illi Delet ea{m} penit{us} scribens quod p{ro}uenit inde. [Sidenote: The fourth case of the craft.] ¶ Her{e} is že 4 case, že quych is: yf hit be happe žat že než{er} figur{e} schal multiplye žat figur{e}, že quych stondes ou{er} žat figures hede, žou schal do away že hier figur{e} & sett ž{er}e žat ž{a}t comys of ž{a}t m{u}ltiplicacio[n~]. As yf ž{er}e come of žat m{u}ltiplicacio[n~] an articuls žou schalt write žere že hier figur{e} stode a 0. ¶ And write že articuls in že lyft side, yf žat hit be a digit write ž{er}e a digit. yf žat h{i}t be a composit, write že digit of že composit. And že articul in že lyft side. al žis is ly[gh]t y-now[gh]t, ž{er}e-for{e} žer nedes no Ensampul. ¶ S{ed} si m{u}ltiplicat alia{m} ponas sup{er} ip{s}am Adiu{n}ges num{er}u{m} que{m} p{re}bet duct{us} ear{um}. [Sidenote: The fifth case of the craft.] ¶ Her{e} is že 5 case, že quych is žis: yf [*leaf 159b] že než{er} figur{e} schul m{u}ltiplie že hier, and žat hier figur{e} is not recte ou{er} his hede. And žat než{er} figur{e} hase ož{er} figures, or on figure ou{er} his hede by m{u}ltiplicacio[n~], žat hase be afor{e}, žou schalt write žat nounbre, že quych comes of žat, ou{er} all{e} že ylke figures hedes, as žus here: +-----+ | 236| |234 | +-----+ Multiply 2 by 2, žat wol be 4; set 4 ou{er} že hede of žat 2. žen[{14}] m{u}ltiplies že hier 2 by že než{er} 3, žat wol be 6. set ou{er} his hede 6, multiplie že hier 2 by že než{er} 4, žat wol be 8. do away že hier 2, že quych stondes ou{er} že hede of že figur{e} of 4, and set ž{er}e 8. And žou schalt haue žis nounb{re} here +-------+ | 46836 | | 234 | +-------+ And antery ži figur{e}s, žat is to say, set ži než{er} 4 vnd{er} že hier 3, and set ži 2 other figures ner{e} hym, so žat že než{er} 2 stonde vnd{ur} že hier 6, že quych 6 stondes in že lyft side. And žat 3 žat stondes vndur 8, as žus aftur [gh]e may se, +-------+ | 46836 | | 234 | +-------+ Now worch forthermor{e}, And m{u}ltiplye žat hier 3 by 2, žat wol be 6, set ž{a}t 6 že quych stondes ou{er} že hede of žat 2, And žen worch as I ta[gh]t že afore. [*leaf 160a] ¶ Si sup{ra}posita cifra debet m{u}ltiplicar{e} Prorsus ea{m} deles & ibi scribi cifra debet. [Sidenote: The sixth case of the craft.] ¶ Her{e} is že 6 case, že quych is žis: yf hit happe žat že figur{e} by že quych žou schal m{u}ltiplye že hier figur{e}, že quych stondes ryght ou{er} hym by a 0, žou schalt do away žat figur{e}, že quych ou{er} žat cifre hede. ¶ And write ž{ere} žat nounbre žat comes of že m{u}ltiplicacio[n~] as žus, 23. do away 2 and sett ž{er}e a 0. vn{de} v{er}sus. ¶ Si cifra m{u}ltiplicat alia{m} posita{m} sup{er} ip{s}am Sitq{ue} locus sup{ra} vacu{us} sup{er} hanc cifra{m} fiet. [Sidenote: The seventh case of the craft.] ¶ Her{e} is že 7 case, že quych is žis: yf a 0 schal m{u}ltiply a figur{e}, že quych stondes not recte ou{er} hym, And ou{er} žat 0 stonde no thyng, žou schalt write ou{er} žat 0 anož{er} 0 as žus: +----+ | 24| |03 | +----+ multiplye 2 be a 0, it wol be nothyng{e}. write žere a 0 ou{er} že hede of že než{er} 0, And žen worch forth til žou come to že ende. ¶ Si sup{ra}[{15}] fuerit cifra sem{per} e{st} p{re}t{er}eunda. [Sidenote: The eighth case of the craft.] ¶ Her{e} is že 8 case, že quych is žis: yf ž{ere} be a 0 or mony cifers in že hier rewe, ž{o}u schalt not m{u}ltiplie hem, bot let hem stonde. And antery že figures beneže to že next figur{e} sygnificatyf as žus: +-----+ |00032|. |22 | +-----+ Ou{er}-lepe all{e} žese cifers & sett žat [*leaf 160b] než{er} 2 žat stondes toward že ryght side, and sett hym vnd{ur} že 3, and sett že ož{er} nether 2 nere hym, so žat he stonde vnd{ur} že thrydde 0, že quych stondes next 3. And žan worch. vnd{e} v{er}sus. ¶ Si dubites, an sit b{e}n{e} m{u}ltiplicac{i}o facta, Diuide totalem nu{mer}u{m} p{er} multiplicante{m}. [Sidenote: How to prove the multiplication.] ¶ Her{e} he teches how žou schalt know whež{er} žou hase wel I-do or no. And he says žat žou schalt deuide all{e} že nounb{r}e žat comes of že m{u}ltiplicacio[n~] by že než{er} figures. And žen žou schalt haue že same nounbur žat ž{o}u hadyst in že begynnyng{e}. but [gh]et žou hast not že craft of dyuisio[n~], but ž{o}u schalt haue hit aft{er}warde. ¶ P{er} num{er}u{m} si vis nu{mer}u{m} q{u}oq{ue} m{u}ltiplicar{e} ¶ T{antu}m p{er} normas subtiles absq{ue} figuris Has normas pot{er}is p{er} v{er}sus scir{e} sequentes. [Sidenote: Mental multiplication.] ¶ Her{e} he teches že to m{u}ltiplie be žow[gh]t figures in ži mynde. And že sentence of žis v{er}se is žis: yf žo{u} wel m{u}ltiplie on nounbre by anož{er} in ži mynde, ž{o}u schal haue ž{er}eto rewles in že v{er}ses žat schal come aft{er}. ¶ Si tu p{er} digitu{m} digitu{m} vis m{u}ltiplicar{e} Re{gula} p{re}cedens dat qualit{er} est op{er}andu{m}. [Sidenote: Digit by digit is easy.] ¶ Her{e} he teches a rewle as žou hast afor{e} to m{u}ltiplie a digit be anož{er}, as yf žou wolde wete qwat is sex tymes 6. žou [*leaf 161a] schalt wete by že rewle žat I ta[gh]t že befor{e}, yf žou haue mynde ž{er}of. ¶ Articulu{m} si p{er} reliquu{m} reliquu{m} vis m{u}lti{plica}r{e} In p{ro}p{r}iu{m} digitu{m} debet vt{er}q{ue} resolui. ¶ Articul{us} digitos post se m{u}ltiplicantes Ex digit{us} quociens retenerit m{u}ltipli{ca}r{i} Articuli faciu{n}t tot centu{m} m{u}ltiplicati. [Sidenote: The first case of the craft. Article by article; an example: another example:] [Headnote: How to work subtly without Figures.] [Sidenote: Mental multiplication. Another example. Another example. Notation. Notation again. Mental multiplication.] ¶ Her{e} he teches že furst rewle, že quych is žis: yf žou wel m{u}ltiplie an articul be anož{er}, so žat both že articuls bene w{i}t{h}-Inne an hundreth, žus ž{o}u schalt do. take že digit of bothe the articuls, for eu{er}y articul hase a digit, žen m{u}ltiplye žat on digit by žat ož{er}, and loke how mony vnytes ben in že nounbre žat comes of že m{u}ltiplicacio[n~] of že 2 digittes, & so mony hundrythes ben in že nounb{re} žat schal come of že m{u}ltiplicacio[n~] of že ylke 2 articuls as žus. yf ž{o}u wold wete qwat is ten tymes ten. take že digit of ten, že quych is 1; take že digit of žat ož{er} ten, že quych is on. ¶ Also m{u}ltiplie 1 be 1, as on tyme on žat is but 1. In on is but on vnite as žou wost welle, ž{er}efor{e} ten tymes ten is but a hundryth. ¶ Also yf žou wold wete what is twenty tymes 30. take že digit of twenty, žat is 2; & take že digitt of thrytty, žat is 3. m{u}ltiplie 3 be 2, žat is 6. Now in 6 ben 6 vnites, ¶ And so mony hundrythes ben in 20 tymes 30[*leaf 161b], ž{ere}for{e} 20 tymes 30 is 6 hundryth eue[n~]. loke & se. ¶ But yf it be so žat on{e} articul be w{i}t{h}-Inne an hundryth, or by-twene an hundryth and a thowsande, so žat it be not a žowsande fully. žen loke how mony vnytes ben in že nounbur žat comys of že m{u}ltiplicacio[n~] [{16}]And so mony tymes[{16}] of 2 digitt{es} of ylke articuls, so mony thowsant ben in že nounbre, the qwych comes of že m{u}ltiplicacio[n~]. And so mony tymes ten thowsand schal be in že nounbre žat comes of že m{u}ltiplicacion of 2 articuls, as yf ž{o}u wold wete qwat is 4 hundryth tymes [two hundryth]. Multiply 4 be 2,[{17}] žat wol be 8. in 8 ben 8 vnites. ¶ And so mony tymes ten thousand be in 4 hundryth tymes [2][{17}] hundryth, ž{a}t is 80 thousand. Take hede, I schall telle že a gen{e}rall{e} rewle whan ž{o}u hast 2 articuls, And žou wold wete qwat comes of že m{u}ltiplicacio[n~] of hem 2. m{u}ltiplie že digit of ž{a}t on articuls, and kepe žat nounbre, žen loke how mony cifers schuld go befor{e} žat on articuls, and he wer{e} write. Als mony cifers schuld go befor{e} žat other, & he wer{e} write of cifers. And haue all{e} že ylke cifers toged{ur} in ži mynde, [*leaf 162a] a-rowe ycho[n~] aftur other, and in že last plase set že nounbre žat comes of že m{u}ltiplicacio[n~] of že 2 digittes. And loke in ži mynde in what place he stondes, wher{e} in že secunde, or in že thryd, or in že 4, or wher{e} ellis, and loke qwat že figures by-token in žat place; & so mych is že nounbre žat comes of že 2 articuls y-m{u}ltiplied to-ged{ur} as žus: yf ž{o}u wold wete what is 20 thousant tymes 3 žowsande. m{u}ltiply že digit of žat articull{e} že quych is 2 by že digitte of žat ož{er} articul že quych is 3, žat wol be 6. žen loke how mony cifers schal go to 20 thousant as hit schuld be write in a tabul. c{er}tainly 4 cifers schuld go to 20 žowsant. ffor žis figure 2 in že fyrst place betokenes twene. ¶ In že secunde place hit betokenes twenty. ¶ In že 3. place hit betokenes 2 hundryth. .¶. In že 4 place 2 thousant. ¶ In že 5 place h{i}t betokenes twenty žousant. ž{ere}for{e} he most haue 4 cifers a-for{e} hym žat he may sto{n}de in že 5 place. kepe žese 4 cifers in thy mynde, žen loke how mony cifers go[n~] to 3 thousant. Certayn to 3 thousante [*leaf 162b] go[n~] 3 cifers afor{e}. Now cast ylke 4 cifers žat schuld go to twenty thousant, And thes 3 cifers žat schuld go afor{e} 3 thousant, & sette hem in rewe ycho[n~] aft{er} ož{er} in ži mynde, as žai schuld stonde in a tabull{e}. And žen schal žou haue 7 cifers; žen sett žat 6 že quych comes of že m{u}ltiplicacio[n~] of že 2 digitt{es} aft{u}r že ylke cifers in že 8 place as yf žat hit stode in a tabul. And loke qwat a figur{e} of 6 schuld betoken in že 8 place. yf hit wer{e} in a tabul & so mych it is. & yf žat figure of 6 stonde in že fyrst place he schuld betoken but 6. ¶ In že 2 place he schuld betoken sexty. ¶ In the 3 place he schuld betoke[n~] sex hundryth. ¶ In že 4 place sex thousant. ¶ In že 5 place sexty žowsant. ¶ In že sext place sex hundryth žowsant. ¶ In že 7 place sex žowsant thousant{es}. ¶ In že 8 place sexty žowsant thousantes. ž{er}for{e} sett 6 in octauo loco, And he schal betoken sexty žowsant thousantes. And so mych is twenty žowsant tymes 3 thousant, ¶ And žis rewle is gen{er}all{e} for all{e} man{er} of articuls, Whethir žai be hundryth or žowsant; but ž{o}u most know well že craft of že wryrchyng{e} in že tabull{e} [*leaf 163a] or žou know to do žus in ži mynde aftur žis rewle. Thou most žat žis rewle holdyže note but wher{e} ž{ere} ben 2 articuls and no mo of že quych ayther of hem hase but on figur{e} significatyf. As twenty tymes 3 thousant or 3 hundryth, and such ož{ur}. ¶ Articulum digito si m{u}ltiplicare o{portet} Articuli digit[i sumi quo multiplicate] Debem{us} reliquu{m} quod m{u}ltiplicat{ur} ab ill{is} P{er} reliq{u}o decuplu{m} sic su{m}ma{m} later{e} neq{ui}b{i}t. [Sidenote: The third case of the craft; an example.] ¶ Her{e} he puttes že thryde rewle, že quych is žis. yf ž{o}u wel m{u}ltiply in ži mynde, And že Articul be a digitte, žou schalt loke žat že digitt be w{i}t{h}-Inne an hundryth, žen žou schalt m{u}ltiply the digitt of že Articulle by že ožer digitte. And eu{er}y vnite in že nounbre žat schall{e} come ž{ere}-of schal betoken ten. As žus: yf žat ž{o}u wold wete qwat is twyes 40. m{u}ltiplie že digitt{e} of 40, že quych is 4, by že ož{er} diget, že quych is 2. And žat wolle be 8. And in že nombre of 8 ben 8 vnites, & eu{er}y of že ylke vnites schuld stonde for 10. ž{ere}-fore ž{ere} schal be 8 tymes 10, žat wol be 4 score. And so mony is twyes 40. ¶ If že articul be a hundryth or be 2 hundryth And a žowsant, so žat hit be notte a thousant, [*leaf 163b] worch as žo{u} dyddyst afor{e}, saue ž{o}u schalt rekene eu{er}y vnite for a hundryth. ¶ In nu{mer}u{m} mixtu{m} digitu{m} si ducer{e} cures Articul{us} mixti sumat{ur} deinde resoluas In digitu{m} post fac respectu de digitis Articul{us}q{ue} docet excrescens in diriua{n}do In digitu{m} mixti post ducas m{u}ltiplica{n}te{m} ¶ De digitis vt norma [{18}][docet] de [hunc] Multiplica si{mu}l et sic postea summa patebit. [Sidenote: The fourth case of the craft: Composite by digit. Mental multiplication.] Here he puttes že 4 rewle, že quych is žis: yf žou m{u}ltipliy on composit be a digit as 6 tymes 24, [{19}]žen take že diget of žat composit, & m{u}ltiply ž{a}t digitt by žat ož{er} diget, and kepe že nomb{ur} žat comes ž{ere}-of. žen take že digit of žat composit, & m{u}ltiply žat digit by anož{er} diget, by že quych ž{o}u hast m{u}ltiplyed že diget of že articul, and loke qwat comes ž{ere}-of. žen take ž{o}u žat nounbur, & cast hit to žat other nounbur žat ž{o}u secheste as žus yf žou wel wete qwat comes of 6 tymes 4 & twenty. multiply žat articull{e} of že composit by že digit, že quych is 6, as yn že thryd rewle ž{o}u was tau[gh]t, And žat schal be 6 scor{e}. žen m{u}ltiply že diget of že {com}posit, [*leaf 164a] že quych is 4, and m{u}ltiply žat by žat other diget, že quych is 6, as žou wast tau[gh]t in že first rewle, yf ž{o}u haue mynde ž{er}of, & žat wol be 4 & twenty. cast all ylke nounburs to-ged{ir}, & hit schal be 144. And so mych is 6 tymes 4 & twenty. [Headnote: How to multiply without Figures.] ¶ Duct{us} in articulu{m} num{erus} si {com}posit{us} sit Articulu{m} puru{m} comites articulu{m} q{u}o{que} Mixti pro digit{is} post fiat [et articulus vt] Norma iubet [retinendo quod extra dicta ab illis] Articuli digitu{m} post tu mixtu{m} digitu{m} duc Re{gula} de digitis nec p{re}cipit articul{us}q{ue} Ex quib{us} exc{re}scens su{m}me tu iunge p{ri}ori Sic ma{n}ifesta cito fiet t{ibi} su{m}ma petita. [Sidenote: The fifth case of the craft: Article by Composite. An example.] ¶ Her{e} he puttes že 5 rewle, že quych is žis: yf ž{o}u wel m{u}ltiply an Articul be a composit, m{u}ltiplie žat Articul by že articul of že composit, and worch as žou wos tau[gh]t in že secunde rewle, of že quych rewle že v{er}se begynnes žus. ¶ Articulu{m} si p{er} Relicu{m} vis m{u}ltiplicare. žen m{u}ltiply že diget of že composit by žat ož{ir} articul aft{ir} že doctrine of že 3 rewle. take ž{er}of gode hede, I p{ra}y že as žus. Yf ž{o}u wel wete what is 24 tymes ten. Multiplie ten by 20, žat wel be 2 hundryth. žen m{u}ltiply že diget of že 10, že quych is 1, by že diget of že composit, že quych is 4, & ž{a}t [*leaf 164b] wol be 4. žen reken eu{er}y vnite žat is in 4 for 10, & žat schal be 40. Cast 40 to 2 hundryth, & žat wol be 2 hundryth & 40. And so mych is 24 tymes ten. [Headnote: How to work without Figures.] ¶ Compositu{m} num{er}u{m} mixto si[c] m{u}ltiplicabis Vndecies tredeci{m} sic e{st} ex hiis op{er}andum In reliquu{m} p{rimu}m demu{m} duc post in eund{em} Vnu{m} post den{u}m duc in t{ri}a dei{n}de p{er} vnu{m} Multiplices{que} dem{u}m int{ra} o{mn}ia m{u}ltiplicata In su{m}ma decies q{ua}m si fu{er}it t{ibi} doces Multiplicandor{um} de normis sufficiunt h{ec}. [Sidenote: The sixth case of the craft: Composite by Composite. Mental multiplication. An example of the sixth case of the craft.] ¶ Here he puttes že 6 rewle, & že last of all{e} multiplicacio[n~], že quych is žis: yf ž{o}u wel m{u}ltiplye a {com}posit by a-nož{er} composit, žou schalt do žus. m{u}ltiplie ž{a}t on composit, qwych ž{o}u welt of the twene, by že articul of že tož{er} composit, as ž{o}u wer{e} tau[gh]t in že 5 rewle, žen m{u}ltiplie ž{a}t same composit, že quych žou hast m{u}ltiplied by že ož{er} articul, by že digit of že ož{er} composit, as ž{o}u was tau[gh]t in že 4 rewle. As žus, yf žou wold wete what is 11 tymes 13, as ž{o}u was tau[gh]t in že 5 rewle, & žat schal be an hundryth & ten, aft{er}warde m{u}ltiply žat same co{m}posit ž{a}t ž{o}u hast m{u}ltiplied, že quych is a .11. And m{u}ltiplye hit be že digit of že ož{er} composit, že quych is 3, for 3 is že digit of 13, And žat wel be 30. žen take že digit of žat composit, že quych composit žou m{u}ltiplied by že digit of ž{a}t ož{er} {com}posit, [*leaf 165a] že quych is a 11. ¶ Also of the quych 11 on is že digit. m{u}ltiplie žat digitt by že digett of žat oth{er} composit, že quych diget is 3, as ž{o}u was tau[gh]t in že first rewle i{n} že begynnyng{e} of žis craft. že quych rewle begynn{es} "In digitu{m} cures." And of all{e} že m{u}ltiplicacio[n~] of že 2 digitt comys thre, for onys 3 is but 3. Now cast all{e} žese nounbers toged{ur}, the quych is žis, a hundryth & ten & 30 & 3. And al žat wel be 143. Write 3 first in že ryght side. And cast 10 to 30, žat wol be 40. set 40 next aft{ur} towarde že lyft side, And set aftur a hundryth as her{e} an Ensampull{e}, 143. (Cetera desunt.) FOOTNOTES (The Crafte of Nombrynge): [1: In MS, 'awiy.'] [2: 'ben' repeated in MS.] [3: In MS. 'thausandes.'] [4: Perhaps "So."] [5: 'hali' marked for erasure in MS.] [6: 'moy' in MS.] [7: 'Subt{ra}has a{u}t addis a dext{ri}s {ve}l medi{a}b{is}' added on margin of MS.] [8: After 'craft' insert 'the .4. what is že p{ro}fet of žis craft.'] [9: After 'sythes' insert '& žis wordes fyue sithe & sex sythes.'] [10: 't'l' marked for erasure before 'tyl' in MS.] [11: Here 'of že same rew' is marked for erasure in MS.] [12: 's{ed}' deleted in MS.] [13: 6883 in MS.] [14: 'žen' overwritten on 'žat' marked for erasure.] [15: 'Supra' inserted in MS. in place of 'cifra' marked for erasure.] [16--16: Marked for erasure in MS.] [17: 4 in MS.] [18: docet. decet MS.] [19: '4 times 4' in MS.] +The Art of Nombryng.+ A TRANSLATION OF +John of Holywood's De Arte Numerandi.+ [_Ashmole MS. 396, fol. 48._] +Boys seying in the begynnyng of his Arsemetrik{e}:--All{e} [*Fol. 48.] thynges that ben{e} fro the first begynnyng of thynges have p{ro}ceded{e}, and come forth{e}, And by reso{u}n of nombre ben formed{e}; And in wise as they ben{e}, So oweth{e} they to be knowen{e}; wherfor in vniu{er}sall{e} knowlechyng of thynges the Art of nombrynge is best, and most operatyf{e}.+ [Sidenote: The name of the art. Derivation of Algorism. Another. Another. Kinds of numbers. The 9 rules of the Art.] Therfore sithen the science of the whiche at this tyme we intenden{e} to write of standith{e} all{e} and about nombre: ffirst we most se, what is the p{ro}pre name therof{e}, and fro whens the name come: Afterward{e} what is nombre, And how manye spices of nombre ther ben. The name is cleped{e} Algorisme, had{e} out of Algor{e}, other of Algos, in grewe, That is clepid{e} in englissh{e} art other craft, And of Rithm{us} that is called{e} nombre. So algorisme is cleped{e} the art of nombryng, other it is had of{e} en or in, and gogos that is introduccio{u}n, and Rithm{us} nombre, that is to say Interduccio{u}n of nombre. And thirdly it is had{e} of the name of a kyng that is cleped{e} Algo and Rythm{us}; So called{e} Algorism{us}. Sothely .2. maner{e} of nombres ben notified{e}; Formall{e},[{1}] as nombr{e} i{s} vnitees gadred{e} to-gedres; Materiall{e},[{2}] as nombr{e} is a colleccio{u}n of vnitees. Other nombr{e} is a multitude had{e} out of vnitees, vnitee is that thynge wher-by eu{er}y thynge is called{e} oone, other o thynge. Of nombres, that one is cleped{e} digitall{e}, that other{e} Article, Another a nombre componed{e} ož{er} myxt. Another digitall{e} is a nombre w{i}t{h}-in .10.; Article is ž{a}t nombre that may be dyvyded{e} in .10. p{ar}ties egally, And that there leve no residue; Componed{e} or medled{e} is that nombre that is come of a digite and of an article. And vndrestand{e} wele that all{e} nombres betwix .2. articles next is a nombr{e} componed{e}. Of this art ben{e} .9. spices, that is forto sey, num{er}acio{u}n, addicio{u}n, Subtraccio{u}n, Mediac{i}o{u}n, Duplacio{u}n, Multipliacio{u}n, Dyvysio{u}n, Progressio{u}n, And of Rootes the extraccio{u}n, and that may be had{e} in .2. maners, that is to sey in nombres quadrat, and in cubic{es}: Amonge the which{e}, ffirst of Num{er}acio{u}n, and aft{er}ward{e} of že ož{er}s by ordure, y entende to write. [Headnote: Chapter I. Numeration.] [*Fol. 48b] +For-soth{e} num{er}acio{u}n is of eu{er}y numbre by competent figures an artificiall{e} rep{re}sentacio{u}n.+ [Sidenote: Figures, differences, places, and limits. The 9 figures. The cipher. The numeration of digits, of articles, of composites. The value due to position. Numbers are written from right to left.] Sothly figure, difference, places, and lynes supposen o thyng other the same, But they ben sette here for dyue{r}s resons. ffigure is cleped{e} for p{ro}traccio{u}n of figuracio{u}n; Difference is called{e} for therby is shewed{e} eu{er}y figure, how it hath{e} difference fro the figures before them: place by cause of space, where-in me writeth{e}: lynees, for that is ordeyned{e} for the p{re}sentacio{u}n of eu{er}y figure. And vnderstonde that ther ben .9. lymytes of figures that rep{re}senten the .9. digit{es} that ben these. 0. 9. 8. 7. 6. 5. 4. 3. 2. 1. The .10. is cleped{e} theta, or a cercle, other a cifre, other a figure of nought for nought it signyfieth{e}. Nathelesse she holdyng that place giveth{e} others for to signyfie; for with{e}-out cifre or cifres a pure article may not be writte. And sithen that by these .9. figures significatif{es} Ioyned{e} w{i}t{h} cifre or w{i}t{h} cifres all{e} nombres ben and may be rep{re}sented{e}, It was, nether is, no nede to fynde any more figures. And note wele that eu{er}y digite shall{e} be writte w{i}t{h} oo figure allone to it ap{ro}pred{e}. And all{e} articles by a cifre, ffor eu{er}y article is named{e} for oone of the digitis as .10. of 1.. 20. of. 2. and so of the others, &c. And all{e} nombres digitall{e} owen to be sette in the first difference: All{e} articles in the seconde. Also all{e} nombres fro .10. til an .100. [which] is excluded{e}, with .2. figures mvst be writte; And yf it be an article, by a cifre first put, and the figure y-writte toward{e} the lift hond{e}, that signifieth{e} the digit of the which{e} the article is named{e}; And yf it be a nombre componed{e}, ffirst write the digit that is a part of that componed{e}, and write to the lift side the article as it is seid{e} be-fore. All{e} nombre that is fro an hundred{e} tille a thousand{e} exclused{e}, owith{e} to be writ by .3. figures; and all{e} nombre that is fro a thousand{e} til .x. M[~l]. mvst be writ by .4. figures; And so forthe. And vnderstond{e} wele that eu{er}y figure sette in the first place signyfieth{e} his digit; In the second{e} place .10. tymes his digit; In the .3. place an hundred{e} so moche; In the .4. place a thousand{e} so moche; In the .5. place .x. thousand{e} so moch{e}; In the .6. place an hundred{e} thousand{e} so moch{e}; In the .7. place a thousand{e} thousand{e}. And so infynytly mvltiplying by [*Fol. 49.] these .3. 10, 100, 1000. And vnderstand{e} wele that competently me may sette vpon figure in the place of a thousand{e}, a prik{e} to shewe how many thousand{e} the last figure shall{e} rep{re}sent. We writen{e} in this art to the lift side-ward{e}, as arabien{e} writen{e}, that weren fynders of this science, other{e} for this reso{u}n, that for to kepe a custumable ordr{e} in redyng, Sette we all{e}-wey the more nombre before. [Headnote: Chapter II. Addition.] [Sidenote: Definition. How the numbers should be written. The method of working. Begin at the right. The Sum is a digit, or an article, or a composite.] Addicio{u}n is of nombre other of nombres vnto nombre or to nombres aggregacio{u}n, that me may see that that is come therof as exc{re}ssent. In addicio{u}n, 2. ordres of figures and .2. nombres ben necessary, that is to sey, a nombre to be added{e} and the nombre wherto the addic{i}oun shold{e} be made to. The nombre to be added{e} is that žat shold{e} be added{e} therto, and shall{e} be vnderwriten; the nombre vnto the which{e} addicio{u}n shall{e} be made to is that nombre that resceyueth{e} the addicion of žat other, and shall{e} be writen above; and it is convenient that the lesse nombre be vnderwrit, and the more added{e}, than the contrary. But whether it happ{e} one other other, the same comyth{e} of, Therfor, yf žow wilt adde nombre to nombre, write the nombre wherto the addicio{u}n shall{e} be made in the omest ordre by his differences, so that the first of the lower ordre be vndre the first of the omyst ordre, and so of others. That done, adde the first of the lower ordre to the first of the omyst ordre. And of such{e} addicio{u}n, other ž{er}e grow{i}t{h} therof a digit, An article, other a composed{e}. If it be digit{us}, In the place of the omyst shalt thow write the digit excrescyng, as thus:-- +----------------------------+---+ |The resultant | 2 | +----------------------------+---+ |To whom it shal be added{e} | 1 | +----------------------------+---+ |The nombre to be added{e} | 1 | +----------------------------+---+ If the article; in the place of the omyst put a-way by a cifre writte, and the digit transferred{e}, of že which{e} the article toke his name, toward{e} the lift side, and be it added{e} to the next figure folowyng, yf ther be any figure folowyng; or no, and yf it be not, leve it [in the] void{e}, as thus:-- +---------------------------------+----+ | The resultant | 10 | +---------------------------------+----+ | To whom it shall{e} be added{e} | 7 | +---------------------------------+----+ | The nombre to be added{e} | 3 | +---------------------------------+----+ +----------------------+---+---+---+---+---+ | Resultans | 2 | 7 | 8 | 2 | 7 | +----------------------+---+---+---+---+---+ | Cui d{ebet} addi | 1 | 0 | 0 | 8 | 4 | +----------------------+---+---+---+---+---+ | Num{erus} addend{us} | 1 | 7 | 7 | 4 | 3 | +----------------------+---+---+---+---+---+ And yf it happe that the figure folowyng wherto the addicio{u}n shall{e} be made by [the cifre of] an article, it sette a-side; In his place write the [*Fol. 49b] [digit of the] Article as thus:-- +---------------------------------+----+ | The resultant | 17 | +---------------------------------+----+ | To whom it shall{e} be added{e} | 10 | +---------------------------------+----+ | The nombre to be added{e} | 7 | +---------------------------------+----+ And yf it happe that a figure of .9. by the figure that me mvst adde [one] to, In the place of that 9. put a cifre {and} write že article toward{e} že lift hond{e} as bifore, and thus:-- +---------------------------------+----+ | The resultant | 10 | +---------------------------------+----+ | To whom it shall{e} be added{e} | 9 | +---------------------------------+----+ | The nombre to be added{e} | 1 | +---------------------------------+----+ And yf[{3}] [therefrom grow a] nombre componed,[{4}] [in the place of the nombre] put a-way[{5}][let] the digit [be][{6}]writ ž{a}t is part of ž{a}t co{m}posid{e}, and žan put to že lift side the article as before, and žus:-- +---------------------------------+----+ | The resultant | 12 | +---------------------------------+----+ | To whom it shall{e} be added{e} | 8 | +---------------------------------+----+ | The nombre to be added{e} | 4 | +---------------------------------+----+ This done, adde the seconde to the second{e}, and write above ož{er} as before. [Sidenote: The translator's note.] Note wele ž{a}t in addic{i}ons and in all{e} spices folowyng, whan he seith{e} one the other shall{e} be writen aboue, and me most vse eu{er} figure, as that eu{er}y figure were sette by half{e}, and by hym-self{e}. [Headnote: Chapter III. Subtraction.] [Sidenote: Definition of Subtraction. How it may be done. What is required. Write the greater number above. Subtract the first figure if possible. If it is not possible 'borrow ten,' and then subtract.] Subtraccio{u}n is of .2. p{ro}posed{e} nombres, the fyndyng of the excesse of the more to the lasse: Other subtraccio{u}n is ablacio{u}n of o nombre fro a-nother, that me may see a some left. The lasse of the more, or even of even, may be w{i}t{h}draw; The more fro the lesse may neu{er} be. And sothly that nombre is more that hath{e} more figures, So that the last be signyficatife{s}: And yf ther ben as many in that one as in that other, me most deme it by the last, other by the next last. More-ou{er} in w{i}t{h}-drawyng .2. nombres ben necessary; A nombre to be w{i}t{h}draw, And a nombre that me shall{e} w{i}t{h}-draw of. The nombre to be w{i}t{h}-draw shall{e} be writ in the lower ordre by his differences; The nombre fro the which{e} me shall{e} with{e}-draw in the omyst ordre, so that the first be vnder the first, the second{e} vnder the second{e}, And so of all{e} others. With{e}-draw therfor the first of the lower{e} ordre fro the first of the ordre above his hede, and that wolle be other more or lesse, ož{er} egall{e}. +---------------------------------+----+ | The remanent | 20 | +---------------------------------+----+ | Wherof me shall{e} w{i}t{h}draw | 22 | +---------------------------------+----+ | The nombre to be w{i}t{h}draw | 2 | +---------------------------------+----+ yf it be egall{e} or even the figure sette beside, put in his place a cifre. And yf it be more put away ž{er}fro als many of vnitees the lower figure conteyneth{e}, and writ the residue as thus +----------------------------------+---+---+ | The remanent | 2 | 2 | +----------------------------------+---+---+ | Wherof me shall{e} w{i}t{h}-draw | 2 | 8 | +----------------------------------+---+---+ | Že nombre to be w{i}t{h}draw | | 6 | +----------------------------------+---+---+ [*Fol. 50.] +--------------------------+---+---+-----+---+---+---+---+---+---+ | Remane{n}s | 2 | 2 | 1 | 8 | 2 | 9 | 9 | 9 | 8 | +--------------------------+---+---+-----+---+---+---+---+---+---+ | A quo sit subtraccio | 8 | 7 | 2 | 4 | 3 | 0 | 0 | 0 | 4 | +--------------------------+---+---+-----+---+---+---+---+---+---+ | Numerus subt{ra}hend{us} | 6 | 5 |[{7}]|[6]| . | . | . | . | 6 | +--------------------------+---+---+-----+---+---+---+---+---+---+ And yf it be lesse, by-cause the more may not be w{i}t{h}-draw ther-fro, borow an vnyte of the next figure that is worth{e} 10. Of that .10. and of the figure that ye wold{e} have w{i}t{h}-draw fro be-fore to-gedre Ioyned{e}, w{i}t{h}-draw že figure be-nethe, and put the residue in the place of the figure put a-side as ž{us}:-- +----------------------------------+---+---+ | The remanent | 1 | 8 | +----------------------------------+---+---+ | Wherof me shall{e} w{i}t{h}-draw | 2 | 4 | +----------------------------------+---+---+ | The nombre to be w{i}t{h}-draw | 0 | 6 | +----------------------------------+---+---+ [Sidenote: If the second figure is one.] And yf the figure wherof me shal borow the vnyte be one, put it a-side, and write a cifre in the place ž{er}of, lest the figures folowing faile of thair{e} nombre, and žan worch{e} as it shew{i}t{h} in this figure here:-- +--------------------------------+---+---+------+ | The remanent | 3 | 0 |9[{8}]| +--------------------------------+---+---+------+ | Wherof me shal w{i}t{h}-draw | 3 | 1 | 2 | +--------------------------------+---+---+------+ | The nombre to be w{i}t{h}-draw | . | . | 3 | +--------------------------------+---+---+------+ [Sidenote: If the second figure is a cipher.] And yf the vnyte wherof me shal borow be a cifre, go ferther to the figure signyficatif{e}, and ther borow one, and reto{ur}nyng bak{e}, in the place of eu{er}y cifre ž{a}t ye passid{e} ou{er}, sette figures of .9. as here it is specified{e}:-- +----------------------------------+---+---+---+---+---+ | The remenaunt | 2 | 9 | 9 | 9 | 9 | +----------------------------------+---+---+---+---+---+ | Wherof me shall{e} w{i}t{h}-draw | 3 | 0 | 0 | 0 | 3 | +----------------------------------+---+---+---+---+---+ | The nombre to be w{i}t{h}-draw | | | | | 4 | +----------------------------------+---+---+---+---+---+ [Sidenote: A justification of the rule given. Why it is better to work from right to left. How to prove subtraction, and addition.] And whan me cometh{e} to the nombre wherof me intendith{e}, there remayneth{e} all{e}-wayes .10. ffor že which{e} .10. &c. The reson why žat for eu{er}y cifre left behynde me setteth figures ther of .9. this it is:--If fro the .3. place me borowed{e} an vnyte, that vnyte by respect of the figure that he came fro rep{re}sentith an .C., In the place of that cifre [passed over] is left .9., [which is worth ninety], and yit it remayneth{e} as .10., And the same reson{e} wold{e} be yf me had{e} borowed{e} an vnyte fro the .4., .5., .6., place, or ony other so vpward{e}. This done, withdraw the second{e} of the lower ordre fro the figure above his hede of že omyst ordre, and wirch{e} as before. And note wele that in addicion or in subtracc{i}o{u}n me may wele fro the lift side begynne and ryn to the right side, But it wol be more p{ro}fitabler to be do, as it is taught. And yf thow wilt p{ro}ve yf thow have do wele or no, The figures that thow hast withdraw, adde them ayene to the omyst figures, and they wolle accorde w{i}t{h} the first that thow haddest yf thow have labored wele; and in like wise in addicio{u}n, whan thow hast added{e} all{e} thy figures, w{i}t{h}draw them that thow first [*Fol. 50b] addest, and the same wolle reto{ur}ne. The subtraccio{u}n is none other but a p{ro}uff{e} of the addicio{u}n, and the contrarye in like wise. [Headnote: Chapter IV. Mediation.] [Sidenote: Definition of mediation. Where to begin. If the first figure is unity. What to do if it is not unity.] Mediacio{u}n is the fyndyng of the halfyng of eu{er}y nombre, that it may be seyn{e} what and how moch{e} is eu{er}y half{e}. In halfyng ay oo order of figures and oo nombre is necessary, that is to sey the nombre to be halfed{e}. Therfor yf thow wilt half any nombre, write that nombre by his differences, and begynne at the right, that is to sey, fro the first figure to the right side, so that it be signyficatif{e} other rep{re}sent vnyte or eny other digitall{e} nombre. If it be vnyte write in his place a cifre for the figures folowyng, [lest they signify less], and write that vnyte w{i}t{h}out in the table, other resolue it in .60. mynvt{es} and sette a-side half of tho m{inutes} so, and reserve the remen{au}nt w{i}t{h}out in the table, as thus .30.; other sette w{i}t{h}out thus .{d[-i]}: that kepeth{e} none ordre of place, Nathelesse it hath{e} signyficacio{u}n. And yf the other figure signyfie any other digital nombre fro vnyte forth{e}, ož{er} the nombre is od{e} or even{e}. If it be even, write this half in this wise:-- +-----------------+---+---+ | Halfed{e} | 2 | 2 | +-----------------+----+--+ | to be halfed{e} | 4 | 4 | +-----------------+---+---+ And if it be odde, Take the next even vndre hym conteyned{e}, and put his half in the place of that odde, and of že vnyte that remayneth{e} to be halfed{e} do thus:-- +-----------------+---+---+ | halfed{e} | 2 | 3 | [di] +-----------------+---+---+ | To be halfed{e} | 4 | 7 | +-----------------+---+---+ [Sidenote: Then halve the second figure. If it is odd, add 5 to the figure before.] This done, the second{e} is to be halfed{e}, yf it be a cifre put it be-side, and yf it be significatif{e}, other it is even or od{e}: If it be even, write in the place of že nombres wiped{e} out the half{e}; yf it be od{e}, take the next even vnder it co{n}tenyth{e}, and in the place of the Impar sette a-side put half of the even: The vnyte that remayneth{e} to be halfed{e}, respect had{e} to them before, is worth{e} .10. Dyvide that .10. in .2., 5. is, and sette a-side that one, and adde that other to the next figure p{re}cedent as here:-- +-----------------+---+---+---+ | Halfed{e} | | | | +-----------------+---+---+---+ | to be halfed{e} | | | | +-----------------+---+---+---+ And yf že addicio{u}n shold{e} be made to a cifre, sette it a-side, and write in his place .5. And vnder this fo{ur}me me shall{e} write and worch{e}, till{e} the totall{e} nombre be halfed{e}. +------------------+---+---+---+---+---+----+----+---+ | doubled{e} | 2 | 6 | 8 | 9 | 0 | 10 | 17 | 4 | +------------------+---+---+---+---+---+----+----+---+ | to be doubled{e} | 1 | 3 | 4 | 4 | 5 | 5 | 8 | 7 | +------------------+---+---+---+---+---+----+----+---+ [Headnote: Chapter V. Duplation.] [Sidenote: Definition of Duplation. Where to begin. Why. What to do with the result.] Duplicacio{u}n is ag{re}gacion of nombre [to itself] žat me may se the nombre growen. In doublyng{e} ay is but one ordre of figures necessarie. And me most be-gynne w{i}t{h} the lift side, other of the more figure, And after the nombre of the more figure rep{re}sentith{e}. [*Fol. 51.] In the other .3. before we begynne all{e} way fro the right side and fro the lasse nombre, In this spice and in all{e} other folowyng we wolle begynne fro the lift side, ffor and me bigon th{e} double fro the first, omwhile me myght double oo thynge twyes. And how be it that me myght double fro the right, that wold{e} be harder in techyng and in workyng. Therfor yf thow wolt double any nombre, write that nombre by his differences, and double the last. And of that doubly{n}g other growith{e} a nombre digital, article, or componed{e}. [If it be a digit, write it in the place of the first digit.] If it be article, write in his place a cifre and transferre the article toward{e} the lift, as thus:-- +------------------+----+ | double | 10 | +------------------+----+ | to be doubled{e} | 5 | +------------------+----+ And yf the nombre be componed{e}, write a digital that is part of his composicio{u}n, and sette the article to the lift hand{e}, as thus:-- +------------------+----+ | doubled{e} | 16 | +------------------+----+ | to be doubled{e} | 8 | +------------------+----+ That done, me most double the last save one, and what groweth{e} ž{er}of me most worche as before. And yf a cifre be, touch{e} it not. But yf any nombre shall{e} be added{e} to the cifre, in že place of že figure wiped{e} out me most write the nombre to be added{e}, as thus:-- +------------------+---+---+---+ | doubled{e} | 6 | 0 | 6 | +------------------+---+---+---+ | to be doubled{e} | 3 | 0 | 3 | +------------------+---+---+---+ [Sidenote: How to prove your answer.] In the same wise me shall{e} wirch{e} of all{e} others. And this p{ro}bacio{u}n: If thow truly double the halfis, and truly half the doubles, the same nombre and figure shall{e} mete, such{e} as thow labo{ur}ed{e} vpon{e} first, And of the contrarie. +------------------+---+---+---+ | Doubled{e} | 6 | 1 | 8 | +------------------+---+---+---+ | to be doubled{e} | 3 | 0 | 9 | +------------------+---+---+---+ [Headnote: Chapter VI. Multiplication.] [Sidenote: Definition of Multiplication. Multiplier. Multiplicand. Product.] Multiplicacio{u}n of nombre by hym-self other by a-nother, w{i}t{h} p{ro}posid{e} .2. nombres, [is] the fyndyng of the third{e}, That so oft conteyneth{e} that other, as ther ben vnytes in the ož{er}. In multiplicacio{u}n .2. nombres pryncipally ben necessary, that is to sey, the nombre multiplying and the nombre to be multiplied{e}, as here;--twies fyve. [The number multiplying] is designed{e} adu{er}bially. The nombre to be multiplied{e} resceyveth{e} a no{m}i{n}all{e} appellacio{u}n, as twies .5. 5. is the nombre multiplied{e}, and twies is the nombre to be multipliede. +-----------------+-----+---+---++---+---+---+---+---+---+---+---+---+ | Resultans |[{9}]| 1 | 0 || 1 | 3 | 2 | 6 | 6 | 8 | 0 | 0 | 8 | +-----------------+-----+---+---++---+---+---+---+---+---+---+---+---+ | Multiplicand{us}| . | . | 5 || . | . | 4 | . | 3 | 4 | 0 | 0 | 4 | +-----------------+-----+---+---++---+---+---+---+---+---+---+---+---+ | Multiplicans | . | 2 | 2 || . | 3 | 3 | 2 | 2 | 2 | . | . | . | +-----------------+-----+---+---++---+---+---+---+---+---+---+---+---+ Also me may thervpon{e} to assigne the. 3. nombre, the which{e} is [*Fol. 51b] cleped{e} p{ro}duct or p{ro}venient, of takyng out of one fro another: as twyes .5 is .10., 5. the nombre to be multiplied{e}, and .2. the multipliant, and. 10. as before is come therof. And vnderstonde wele, that of the multipliant may be made the nombre to be multiplied{e}, and of the contrarie, remaynyng eu{er} the same some, and herof{e} cometh{e} the comen speche, that seith{e} all nombre is converted{e} by Multiplying in hym-self{e}. +----+----+----+----+----+--------+----+----+----+-----+ | 1 | 2 | 3 | 4 | 5 | 6 | 7 | 8 | 9 | 10 | +----+----+----+----+----+--------+----+----+----+-----+ | 2 | 4 | 6 | 8 | 10 |10[{10}]| 14 | 16 | 18 | 20 | +----+----+----+----+----+--------+----+----+----+-----+ | 3 | 6 | 9 | 12 | 15 | 18 | 21 | 24 | 27 | 30 | +----+----+----+----+----+--------+----+----+----+-----+ | 4 | 8 | 12 | 16 | 20 | 24 | 28 | 32 | 36 | 40 | +----+----+----+----+----+--------+----+----+----+-----+ | 5 | 10 | 15 | 20 | 25 | 30 | 35 | 40 | 45 | 50 | +----+----+----+----+----+--------+----+----+----+-----+ | 6 | 12 | 18 | 24 | 30 | 36 | 42 | 48 | 56 | 60 | +----+----+----+----+----+--------+----+----+----+-----+ | 7 | 14 | 21 | 28 | 35 | 42 | 49 | 56 | 63 | 70 | +----+----+----+----+----+--------+----+----+----+-----+ | 8 | 16 | 24 | 32 | 40 | 48 | 56 | 64 | 72 | 80 | +----+----+----+----+----+--------+----+----+----+-----+ | 9 | 18 | 27 | 36 | 45 | 54 | 63 | 72 | 81 | 90 | +----+----+----+----+----+--------+----+----+----+-----+ | 10 | 20 | 30 | 40 | 50 | 60 | 70 | 80 | 90 | 100 | +----+----+----+----+----+--------+----+----+----+-----+ [Headnote: The Cases of Multiplication.] [Sidenote: There are 6 rules of Multiplication. (1) Digit by digit. See the table above. (2) Digit by article. (3) Composite by digit.] And ther ben .6 rules of Multiplicacio{u}n; ffirst, yf a digit multiplie a digit, considr{e} how many of vnytees ben betwix the digit by multiplying and his .10. beth{e} to-gedre accompted{e}, and so oft w{i}t{h}-draw the digit multiplying, vnder the article of his deno{m}i{n}acio{u}n. Example of grace. If thow wolt wete how moch{e} is .4. tymes .8., [{11}]se how many vnytees ben betwix .8.[{12}] and .10. to-geder rekened{e}, and it shew{i}t{h} that .2.: withdraw ther-for the quat{e}rnary, of the article of his deno{m}i{n}acion twies, of .40., And ther remayneth{e} .32., that is, to some of all{e} the multiplicacio{u}n. Wher-vpon for more evidence and declaracion the seid{e} table is made. Whan a digit multiplieth{e} an article, thow most bryng the digit into že digit, of že which{e} the article [has][{13}] his name, and eu{er}y vnyte shall{e} stond{e} for .10., and eu{er}y article an .100. Whan the digit multiplieth{e} a nombre componed{e}, ž{o}u most bryng the digit into aiž{er} part of the nombre componed{e}, so ž{a}t digit be had into digit by the first rule, into an article by že second{e} rule; and aft{er}ward{e} Ioyne the p{ro}duccio{u}n, and ž{er}e wol be the some totall{e}. +----------------+---+---+--++---+---+--++---+---+--++---+---+---+---+ |Resultans | 1 | 2 | 6|| 7 | 3 | 6|| 1 | 2 | 0|| 1 | 2 | 0 | 8 | +----------------+---+---+--++---+---+--++---+---+--++---+---+---+---+ |Multiplicand{us}| | | 2|| | 3 | 2|| | | 6|| | | | 4 | +----------------+---+---+--++---+---+--++---+---+--++---+---+---+---+ |Multiplicans | | 6 | 3|| 2 | 3 | || | 2 | 0|| | 3 | 0 | 2 | +----------------+---+---+--++---+---+--++---+---+--++---+---+---+---+ [Sidenote: (4) Article by article. (5) Composite by article. (6) Composite by composite. How to set down your numbers. If the result is a digit, an article, or a composite. Multiply next by the last but one, and so on.] Whan an article multiplieth{e} an article, the digit wherof he is named{e} is to be brought Into the digit wherof the ož{er} is named{e}, and eu{er}y vnyte wol be worth{e} [*Fol. 52.] an .100., and eu{er}y article. a .1000. Whan an article multiplieth{e} a nombre componed{e}, thow most bryng the digit of the article into aither part of the nombre componed{e}; and Ioyne the p{ro}duccio{u}n, and eu{er}y article wol be worth{e} .100., and eu{er}y vnyte .10., and so woll{e} the some be open{e}. Whan a nombre componed{e} multiplieth{e} a nombre componed{e}, eu{er}y p{ar}t of the nombre multiplying is to be had{e} into eu{er}y p{ar}t of the nombre to be multiplied{e}, and so shall{e} the digit be had{e} twies, onys in the digit, that other in the article. The article also twies, ones in the digit, that other in the article. Therfor yf thow wilt any nombre by hym-self other by any other multiplie, write the nombre to be multiplied{e} in the ou{er} ordre by his differences, The nombre multiplying in the lower ordre by his differences, so that the first of the lower ordre be vnder the last of the ou{er} ordre. This done, of the multiplying, the last is to be had{e} into the last of the nombre to be multiplied{e}. Wherof than wolle grow a digit, an article, other a nombre componed{e}. If it be a digit, even above the figure multiplying is hede write his digit that come of, as it appereth{e} here:-- +-----------------------+---+ | The resultant | 6 | +-----------------------+---+ | To be multiplied{e} | 3 | +-----------------------+---+ | Že nombre multipliyng | 2 | +-----------------------+---+ And yf an article had be writ ou{er} the fig{ur}e multiplying his hede, put a cifre ž{er} and transferre the article toward{e} the lift hand{e}, as thus:-- +-------------------------+---+---+ | The resultant | 1 | 0 | +-------------------------+---+---+ | to be multiplied{e} | | 5 | +-------------------------+---+---+ | že nombre m{u}ltipliyng | | 2 | +-------------------------+---+---+ And yf a nombre componed{e} be writ ou{er} the figure multyplying is hede, write the digit in the nombre componed{e} is place, and sette the article to the lift hand{e}, as thus:-- +------------------------+---+---+ | Resultant | 1 | 2 | +------------------------+---+---+ | to be multiplied{e} | | 4 | +------------------------+---+---+ | the nombre multipliyng | | 3 | +------------------------+---+---+ This done, me most bryng the last save one of the multipliyng into the last of že nombre to be multiplied{e}, and se what comyth{e} therof as before, and so do w{i}t{h} all{e}, tille me come to the first of the nombre multiplying, that must be brought into the last of the nombre to be multiplied{e}, wherof growith{e} ož{er} a digit, an article, [*Fol. 52b] other a nombre componed{e}. If it be a digit, In the place of the ou{er}er, sette a-side, as here: +--------------------------+---+---+ | Resultant | 6 | 6 | +--------------------------+---+---+ | to be multiplied{e} | | 3 | +--------------------------+---+---+ | the nombre m{u}ltipliyng | 2 | 2 | +--------------------------+---+---+ If an article happe, there put a cifre in his place, and put hym to the lift hand{e}, as here: +-------------------------+---+---+---+ | The resultant | 1 | 1 | 0 | +-------------------------+---+---+---+ | to be multiplied{e} | | | 5 | +-------------------------+---+---+---+ | že nombre m{u}ltiplying | | 2 | 2 | +-------------------------+---+---+---+ If it be a nombre componed{e}, in the place of the ou{er}er sette a-side, write a digit that[{14}] is a p{ar}t of the componed{e}, and sette on the left hond{e} the article, as here: +-----------------------------+---+-------+---+ | The resultant | 1 |3[{15}]| 2 | +-----------------------------+---+-------+---+ | to be m{u}ltiplied{e} | | | 4 | +-----------------------------+---+-------+---+ | že nombr{e} m{u}ltiplia{n}t | | 3 | 3 | +-----------------------------+---+-------+---+ [Sidenote: Then antery the multiplier one place. Work as before. How to deal with ciphers.] That done, sette forward{e} the figures of the nombre multiplying by oo difference, so that the first of the multipliant be vnder the last save one of the nombre to be multiplied{e}, the other by o place sette forward{e}. Than me shall{e} bryng{e} the last of the m{u}ltipliant in hym to be multiplied{e}, vnder the which{e} is the first multipliant. And than wolle growe ož{er} a digit, an article, or a componed{e} nombre. If it be a digit, adde hym even above his hede; If it be an article, transferre hym to the lift side; And if it be a nombre componed{e}, adde a digit to the figure above his hede, and sette to the lift hand{e} the article. And all{e}-wayes eu{er}y figure of the nombre multipliant is to be brought to the last save one nombre to be multiplied{e}, til me come to the first of the multipliant, where me shall{e} wirche as it is seid{e} before of the first, and aft{er}ward{e} to put forward{e} the figures by o difference and one till{e} they all{e} be multiplied{e}. And yf it happe that the first figure of že multipliant be a cifre, and boue it is sette the figure signyficatif{e}, write a cifre in the place of the figur{e} sette a-side, as thus, {et}c.: +---------------------+---+---+---+ | The resultant | 1 | 2 | 0 | +---------------------+---+---+---+ | to be multiplied{e} | | | 6 | +---------------------+---+---+---+ | the multipliant | | 2 | 0 | +---------------------+---+---+---+ [Sidenote: How to deal with ciphers.] And yf a cifre happe in the lower order be-twix the first and the last, and even above be sette the fig{ur}e signyficatif, leve it vntouched{e}, as here:-- +---------------------+---+---+---+---+---+ | The resultant | 2 | 2 | 6 | 4 | 4 | +---------------------+---+---+---+---+---+ | To be multiplied{e} | | | 2 | 2 | 2 | +---------------------+---+---+---+---+---+ | The multipliant | 1 | 0 | 2 | | | +---------------------+---+---+---+---+---+ And yf the space above sette be void{e}, in that place write thow a cifre. And yf the cifre happe betwix že first and the last to be m{u}ltiplied{e}, me most sette forward{e} the ordre of the figures by thair{e} differences, for oft of duccio{u}n of figur{e}s in cifres nought is the resultant, as here, +-----------------------+---+---+---+---+---+ | Resultant | 8 | 0 | 0 | 8 | | +-----------------------+---+---+---+---+---+ | to be m{u}ltiplied{e} | 4 | 0 | 0 | 4 | | +-----------------------+---+---+---+---+---+ | the m{u}ltipliant | 2 | . | . | . | | +-----------------------+---+---+---+---+---+ [*Fol. 53.] wherof it is evident and open, yf that the first figure of the nombre be to be multiplied{e} be a cifre, vndir it shall{e} be none sette as here:-- +-----------------------+---+---+--------+ | Resultant | 3 | 2 |0[{16}] | +-----------------------+---+---+--------+ | To be m{u}ltiplied{e} | | 8 | 0 | +-----------------------+---+---+--------+ | The m{u}ltipliant | | 4 | | +-----------------------+---+---+--------+ [Sidenote: Leave room between the rows of figures.] Vnder[stand] also that in multiplicacio{u}n, divisio{u}n, and of rootis the extraccio{u}n, competently me may leve a mydel space betwix .2. ordres of figures, that me may write there what is come of addyng other with{e}-drawyng, lest any thynge shold{e} be ou{er}-hipped{e} and sette out of mynde. [Headnote: Chapter VII. Division.] [Sidenote: Definition of division. Dividend, Divisor, Quotient. How to set down your Sum. An example. Examples.] For to dyvyde oo nombre by a-nother, it is of .2. nombres p{ro}posed{e}, It is forto depart the moder nombre into as many p{ar}tis as ben of vnytees in the lasse nombre. And note wele that in makyng{e} of dyvysio{u}n ther ben .3. nombres necessary: that is to sey, the nombre to be dyvyded{e}; the nombre dyvydyng and the nombre exeant, other how oft, or quocient. Ay shall{e} the nombre that is to be dyvyded{e} be more, other at the lest even{e} w{i}t{h} the nombre the dyvysere, yf the nombre shall{e} be mad{e} by hole nombres. Therfor yf thow wolt any nombre dyvyde, write the nombre to be dyvyded{e} in že ou{er}er bordur{e} by his differences, the dyviser{e} in the lower ordur{e} by his differences, so that the last of the dyviser be vnder the last of the nombre to be dyvyde, the next last vnder the next last, and so of the others, yf it may competently be done; as here:-- +------------------+---+---+---+ | The residue | | 2 | 7 | +------------------+---+---+---+ | The quotient | | | 5 | +------------------+---+---+---+ | To be dyvyded{e} | 3 | 4 | 2 | +------------------+---+---+---+ | The dyvyser | | 6 | 3 | +------------------+---+---+---+ +--------------+---+---+----+---+---++---+---+---++---+---+---+ | Residuu{m} | | | 8 || | || | 2 | 7 || | 2 | 6 | +--------------+---+---+---++---+---++---+---+---++---+---+---+ | Quociens | | 2 | 1 || 2 | 2 || | | 5 || | | 9 | +--------------+---+---+---++---+---++---+---+---++---+---+---+ | Diuidend{us} | 6 | 8 | 0 || 6 | 6 || 3 | 4 | 2 || 3 | 3 | 2 | +--------------+---+---+---++---+---++---+---+---++---+---+---+ | Diuiser | 3 | 2 | || 3 | || | 6 | 3 || | 3 | 4 | +--------------+---+---+---++---+---++---+---+---++---+---+---+ [Sidenote: When the last of the divisor must not be set below the last of the dividend. How to begin.] And ther ben .2. causes whan the last figure may not be sette vnder the last, other that the last of the lower nombre may not be w{i}t{h}-draw of the last of the ou{er}er nombre for it is lasse than the lower, other how be it, that it myght be w{i}t{h}-draw as for hym-self fro the ou{er}er the remenaunt may not so oft of them above, other yf že last of the lower be even to the figure above his hede, and že next last ož{er} the figure be-fore ž{a}t be more žan the figure above sette. [*Fol. 53^2.] These so ordeyned{e}, me most wirch{e} from the last figure of že nombre of the dyvyser, and se how oft it may be w{i}t{h}-draw of and fro the figure aboue his hede, namly so that the remen{au}nt may be take of so oft, and to se the residue as here:-- [Sidenote: An example.] +------------------+---+---+---+ | The residue | | 2 | 6 | +------------------+---+---+---+ | The quocient | | | 9 | +------------------+---+---+---+ | To be dyvyded{e} | 3 | 3 | 2 | +------------------+---+---+---+ | The dyvyser | | 3 | 4 | +------------------+---+---+---+ [Sidenote: Where to set the quotiente. Examples.] And note wele that me may not with{e}-draw more than .9. tymes nether lasse than ones. Therfor se how oft že figures of the lower ordre may be w{i}t{h}-draw fro the figures of the ou{er}er, and the nombre that shew{i}t{h} že q{u}ocient most be writ ou{er} the hede of žat figure, vnder the which{e} the first figure is, of the dyviser; And by that figure me most with{e}-draw all{e} ož{er} figures of the lower ordir and that of the figures aboue thair{e} hedis. This so don{e}, me most sette forward{e} že figures of the diuiser by o difference toward{es} the right hond{e} and worch{e} as before; and thus:-- +--------------+---+---+---+---+---+---++---+---+---+---+---+---+---+ | Residuu{m} | | | | | | || | | | | . | 1 | 2 | +--------------+---+---+---+---+---+---++---+---+---+---+---+---+---+ | quo{ciens} | | | | 6 | 5 | 4 || | | | 2 | 0 | 0 | 4 | +--------------+---+---+---+---+---+---++---+---+---+---+---+---+---+ | Diuidend{us} | 3 | 5 | 5 | 1 | 2 | 2 || 8 | 8 | 6 | 3 | 7 | 0 | 4 | +--------------+---+---+---+---+---+---++---+---+---+---+---+---+---+ | Diuisor | | 5 | 4 | 3 | | || 4 | 4 | 2 | 3 | | | | +--------------+---+---+---+---+---+---++---+---+---+---+---+---+---+ +------------------+---+---+---+---+---+---+ | The quocient | | | | 6 | 5 | 4 | +------------------+---+---+---+---+---+---+ | To be dyvyded{e} | 3 | 5 | 5 | 1 | 2 | 2 | +------------------+---+---+---+---+---+---+ | The dyvyser | | 5 | 4 | 3 | | | +------------------+---+---+---+---+---+---+ [Sidenote: A special case.] And yf it happ{e} after že settyng forward{e} of the fig{ur}es ž{a}t že last of the divisor may not so oft be w{i}t{h}draw of the fig{ur}e above his hede, above žat fig{ur}e vnder the which{e} the first of the diuiser is writ me most sette a cifre in ordre of the nombre quocient, and sette the fig{ur}es forward{e} as be-fore be o difference alone, and so me shall{e} do in all{e} nombres to be dyvided{e}, for where the dyviser may not be w{i}t{h}-draw me most sette there a cifre, and sette forward{e} the figures; as here:-- +------------------+---+---+---+---+---+---+---+ | The residue | | | | | | 1 | 2 | |------------------+---+---+---+---+---+---+---+ | The quocient | | | | 2 | 0 | 0 | 4 | |------------------+---+---+---+---+---+---+---+ | To be dyvyded{e} | 8 | 8 | 6 | 3 | 7 | 0 | 4 | |------------------+---+---+---+---+---+---+---+ | The dyvyser | 4 | 4 | 2 | 3 | | | | +------------------+---+---+---+---+---+---+---+ [Sidenote: Another example. What the quotient shows. How to prove your division, or multiplication.] And me shall{e} not cesse fro such{e} settyng of fig{ur}es forward{e}, nether of settyng{e} of že quocient into the dyviser, než{er} of subt{ra}ccio{u}n of the dyvyser, till{e} the first of the dyvyser be w{i}t{h}-draw fro že first to be divided{e}. The which{e} don{e}, or ought,[{17}] ož{er} nought shall{e} remayne: and yf it be ought,[{17}] kepe it in the tables, And eu{er} vny it to že diviser. And yf ž{o}u wilt wete how many vnytees of že divisio{u}n [*Fol. 53^3.] wol growe to the nombre of the diviser{e}, the nombre quocient wol shewe it: and whan such{e} divisio{u}n is made, and ž{o}u lust p{ro}ve yf thow have wele done or no, Multiplie the quocient by the diviser, And the same fig{ur}es wolle come ayene that thow haddest bifore and none other. And yf ought be residue, than w{i}t{h} addicio{u}n therof shall{e} come the same figures: And so multiplicacio{u}n p{ro}vith{e} divisio{u}n, and dyvisio{u}n multiplicacio{u}n: as thus, yf multiplicacio{u}n be made, divide it by the multipliant, and the nombre quocient wol shewe the nombre that was to be multiplied{e}, {et}c. [Headnote: Chapter VIII. Progression.] [Sidenote: Definition of Progression. Natural Progression. Broken Progression. The 1st rule for Natural Progression. The second rule. The first rule of Broken Progression. The second rule.] Progressio{u}n is of nombre after egall{e} excesse fro oone or tweyn{e} take ag{r}egacio{u}n. of p{ro}gressio{u}n one is naturell{e} or co{n}tynuell{e}, ž{a}t ož{er} broken and discontynuell{e}. Naturell{e} it is, whan me begynneth{e} w{i}t{h} one, and kepeth{e} ordure ou{er}lepyng one; as .1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6., {et}c., so ž{a}t the nombre folowyng{e} passith{e} the other be-fore in one. Broken it is, whan me lepith{e} fro o nombre till{e} another, and kepith{e} not the contynuel ordir{e}; as 1. 3. 5. 7. 9, {et}c. Ay me may begynne w{i}t{h} .2., as žus; .2. 4. 6. 8., {et}c., and the nombre folowyng passeth{e} the others by-fore by .2. And note wele, that naturell{e} p{ro}gressio{u}n ay begynneth{e} w{i}t{h} one, and Int{er}cise or broken p{ro}gressio{u}n, omwhile begynnyth{e} w{i}th one, omwhile w{i}t{h} twayn{e}. Of p{ro}gressio{u}n naturell .2. rules ther be yove, of the which{e} the first is this; whan the p{ro}gressio{u}n naturell{e} endith{e} in even nombre, by the half therof multiplie že next totall{e} ou{er}er{e} nombre; Example of grace: .1. 2. 3. 4. Multiplie .5. by .2. and so .10. cometh{e} of, that is the totall{e} nombre ž{er}of. The second{e} rule is such{e}, whan the p{ro}gressio{u}n naturell{e} endith{e} in nombre od{e}. Take the more porcio{u}n of the oddes, and multiplie therby the totall{e} nombre. Example of grace 1. 2. 3. 4. 5., multiplie .5. by .3, and thryes .5. shall{e} be resultant. so the nombre totall{e} is .15. Of p{ro}gresio{u}n int{er}cise, ther ben also .2.[{18}] rules; and že first is žis: Whan the Int{er}cise p{ro}gression endith{e} in even nombre by half therof multiplie the next nombre to žat half{e} as .2.[{18}] 4. 6. Multiplie .4. by .3. so žat is thryes .4., and .12. the nombre of all{e} the p{ro}gressio{u}n, woll{e} folow. The second{e} rule is this: whan the p{ro}gressio{u}n int{er}scise endith{e} in od{e}, take že more porcio{u}n of all{e} že nombre, [*Fol. 53^4.] and multiplie by hym-self{e}; as .1. 3. 5. Multiplie .3. by hym-self{e}, and že some of all{e} wolle be .9., {et}c. [Headnote: Chapter IX. Extraction of Roots.] [Sidenote: The preamble of the extraction of roots. Linear, superficial, and solid numbers. Superficial numbers. Square numbers. The root of a square number. Notes of some examples of square roots here interpolated. Solid numbers. Three dimensions of solids. Cubic numbers. All cubics are solid numbers. No number may be both linear and solid. Unity is not a number.] Here folowith{e} the extraccio{u}n of rotis, and first in nombre q{ua}drat{es}. Wherfor me shall{e} se what is a nombre quadrat, and what is the rote of a nombre quadrat, and what it is to draw out the rote of a nombre. And before other note this divisio{u}n: Of nombres one is lyneal, anož{er} sup{er}ficiall{e}, anož{er} quadrat, anož{er} cubik{e} or hoole. lyneal is that žat is considred{e} after the p{ro}cesse, havyng{e} no respect to the direccio{u}n of nombre in nombre, As a lyne hath{e} but one dymensio{u}n that is to sey after the length{e}. Nombre sup{er}ficial is ž{a}t cometh{e} of ledyng{e} of oo nombre into a-nother, wherfor it is called{e} sup{er}ficial, for it hath{e} .2. nombres notyng or mesuryng{e} hym, as a sup{er}ficiall{e} thyng{e} hath{e} .2. dimensions, ž{a}t is to sey length{e} and brede. And for bycause a nombre may be had{e} in a-nother by .2. man{er}s, ž{a}t is to sey other in hym-self{e}, ož{er} in anož{er}, Vnderstond{e} yf it be had in hym-self, It is a quadrat. ffor dyvisio{u}n write by vnytes, hath{e} .4. sides even as a quadrangill{e}. and yf the nombre be had{e} in a-nož{er}, the nombre is sup{er}ficiel and not quadrat, as .2. had{e} in .3. maketh{e} .6. that is že first nombre sup{er}ficiell{e}; wherfor it is open žat all{e} nombre quadrat is sup{er}ficiel, and not co{n}u{er}tid{e}. The rote of a nombre quadrat is žat nombre that is had of hym-self, as twies .2. makith{e} 4. and .4. is the first nombre quadrat, and 2. is his rote. 9. 8. 7. 6. 5. 4. 3. 2. 1. / The rote of the more quadrat .3. 1. 4. 2. 6. The most nombre quadrat 9. 8. 7. 5. 9. 3. 4. 7. 6. / the remenent ou{er} the quadrat .6. 0. 8. 4. 5. / The first caas of nombre quadrat .5. 4. 7. 5. 6. The rote .2. 3. 4. The second{e} caas .3. 8. 4. 5. The rote .6. 2. The third{e} caas .2. 8. 1. 9. The rote .5. 3. The .4. caas .3. 2. 1. The rote .1. 7. / The 5. caas .9. 1. 2. 0. 4. / The rote 3. 0. 2. The solid{e} nombre or cubik{e} is žat ž{a}t comyt[-h]e of double ledyng of nombre in nombre; And it is cleped{e} a solid{e} body that hath{e} ž{er}-in .3 [dimensions] žat is to sey, length{e}, brede, and thiknesse. so ž{a}t nombre hath{e} .3. nombres to be brought forth{e} in hym. But nombre may be had{e} twies in nombre, for other it is had{e} in hym-self{e}, ož{er} in a-nož{er}. If a nombre be had{e} twies in hym-self, ož{er} ones in his quadrat, ž{a}t is the same, ž{a}t a cubik{e} [*Fol. 54.] is, And is the same that is solide. And yf a nombre twies be had{e} in a-nož{er}, the nombre is cleped{e} solide and not cubik{e}, as twies .3. and ž{a}t .2. makith{e} .12. Wherfor it is opyn{e} that all{e} cubik{e} nombre is solid{e}, and not {con}u{er}tid{e}. Cubik{e} is ž{a}t nombre žat comyth{e} of ledyng{e} of hym-self{e} twyes, or ones in his quadrat. And here-by it is open that o nombre is the roote of a quadrat and of a cubik{e}. Natheles the same nombre is not q{ua}drat and cubik{e}. Opyn{e} it is also that all{e} nombres may be a rote to a q{ua}drat and cubik{e}, but not all{e} nombre quadrat or cubik{e}. Therfor sithen že ledyng{e} of vnyte in hym-self ones or twies nought cometh{e} but vnytes, Seith{e} Boice in Arsemetrik{e}, that vnyte potencially is al nombre, and none in act. And vndirstond{e} wele also that betwix euery .2. quadrat{es} ther is a meene p{ro}porcionall{e}, That is opened{e} thus; lede the rote of o quadrat into the rote of the ož{er} quadrat, and žan wolle že meene shew. [Sidenote: Examples of square roots.] +-------------+-+-+-+-++-+-+-+-++-+-+-+-+-++-+---+------+-+ | Residuu{m} | | |0| || | | |4|| | |0| | || | | 0 | | +-------------+-+-+-+-++-+-+-+-++-+-+-+-+-++-+---+------+-+ | Quadrand{e} |4|3|5|6||3|0|2|9||1|7|4|2|4||1| 9 | 3 |6| +-------------+-+-+-+-++-+-+-+-++-+-+-+-+-++-+---+------+-+ | Duplum |1|2| | ||1|0| | ||2| |6| | || |[8]|[{19}]| | +-------------+-+-+-+-++-+-+-+-++-+-+-+-+-++-+---+------+-+ | Subduplu{m} | |6| |6|| |5| |5||1| |3| |2|| | 4 | |4| +-------------+-+-+-+-++-+-+-+-++-+-+-+-+-++-+---+------+-+ [Sidenote: A note on mean proportionals.] Also betwix the next .2. cubikis, me may fynde a double meene, that is to sey a more meene and a lesse. The more meene thus, as to bryng{e} the rote of the lesse into a quadrat of the more. The lesse thus, If the rote of the more be brought Into the quadrat of the lesse. [Headnote: Chapter X. Extraction of Square Root.] [Sidenote: To find a square root. Begin with the last odd place. Find the nearest square root of that number, subtract, double it, and set the double one to the right. Find the second figure by division. Multiply the double by the second figure, and add after it the square of the second figure, and subtract.] [{20}]To draw a rote of the nombre quadrat it is What-eu{er} nombre be p{ro}posed{e} to fynde his rote and to se yf it be quadrat. And yf it be not quadrat the rote of the most quadrat fynde out, vnder the nombre p{ro}posed{e}. Therfor yf thow wilt the rote of any quadrat nombre draw out, write the nombre by his differences, and compt the nombre of the figures, and wete yf it be od{e} or even. And yf it be even, than most thow begynne worche vnder the last save one. And yf it be od{e} w{i}t{h} the last; and forto sey it shortly, al-weyes fro the last od{e} me shall{e} begynne. Therfor vnder the last in an od place sette, me most fynd{e} a digit, the which{e} lad{e} in hym-self{e} it puttith{e} away that, žat is ou{er} his hede, ož{er} as neigh{e} as me may: suche a digit found{e} and w{i}t{h}draw fro his ou{er}er, me most double that digit and sette the double vnder the next figure toward{e} the right hond{e}, and his vnder double vnder hym. That done, than me most fy{n}d{e} a-nož{er} digit vnder the next figure bifore the doubled{e}, the which{e} [*Fol. 54b] brought in double setteth{e} a-way all{e} that is ou{er} his hede as to reward{e} of the doubled{e}: Than brought into hym-self settith{e} all away in respect of hym-self, Other do it as nye as it may be do: other me may w{i}t{h}-draw the digit [{21}][last] found{e}, and lede hym in double or double hym, and after in hym-self{e}; Than Ioyne to-geder the p{ro}duccion{e} of them bothe, So that the first figure of the last p{ro}duct be added{e} before the first of the first p{ro}duct{es}, the second{e} of the first, {et}c. and so forth{e}, subtrahe fro the totall{e} nombre in respect of že digit. [Sidenote: Examples.] +------------------+-+-+-+-+-++-+-+-+-+-++---+-+---+-+---+-+-+ | The residue | | | | | || | | | | || | | |5| 4 |3|2| +------------------+-+-+-+-+-++-+-+-+-+-++---+-+---+-+---+-+-+ | To be quadred{e} |4|1|2|0|9||1|5|1|3|9|| 9 |0| 0 |5| 4 |3|2| +------------------+-+-+-+-+-++-+-+-+-+-++---+-+---+-+---+-+-+ | The double | |4|0| | || |2| |4| || |6| |0| | |0| +------------------+-+-+-+-+-++-+-+-+-+-++---+-+---+-+---+-+-+ | The vnder double |2| |0| |3||1| |2| |3||[3]| |[0]| |[0]| |0| +------------------+-+-+-+-+-++-+-+-+-+-++---+-+---+-+---+-+-+ [Sidenote: Special cases. The residue.] And if it hap ž{a}t no digit may be found{e}, Than sette a cifre vndre a cifre, and cesse not till{e} thow fynde a digit; and whan thow hast founde it to double it, než{er} to sette the doubled{e} forward{e} nether the vnder doubled{e}, Till thow fynde vndre the first figure a digit, the which{e} lad{e} in all{e} double, settyng away all{e} that is ou{er} hym in respect of the doubled{e}: Than lede hym into hym-self{e}, and put a-way all{e} in regard{e} of hym, other as nygh{e} as thow maist. That done, other ought or nought wolle be the residue. If nought, than it shewith{e} that a nombre componed{e} was the quadrat, and his rote a digit last found{e} w{i}t{h} vnder{e}-double other vndirdoubles, so that it be sette be-fore: And yf ought[{22}] remayn{e}, that shew{i}t{h} that the nombre p{ro}posed{e} was not quadrat,[{23}] [[wher-vpon{e} se the table in the next side of the next leef{e}.]] but a digit [last found with the subduple or subduples is] [Sidenote: This table is constructed for use in cube root sums, giving the value of ab.^2] +---+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+---------+-----+---------+ | 1 | 2 | 3 | 4 | 5 | 6 | 7 | 8 | 9 | +---+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+---------+-----+---------+ | 2 | 8 | 12 | 16 | 20 | 24 | 28 | 32 | 36 | +---+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+---------+-----+---------+ | 3 | 18 | 27 | 36 | 45 | 54 | 63 | 72 | 81 | +---+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+---------+-----+---------+ | 4 | 32 | 48 | 64 | 80 | 96 |112[{24}]| 128 | 144 | +---+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+---------+-----+---------+ | 5 | 50 | 75 | 100 | 125 | 150 | 175 | 200 | 225 | +---+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+---------+-----+---------+ | 6 | 72 | 108 | 144 | 180 | 216 | 252 | 288 | 324 | +---+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+---------+-----+---------+ | 7 | 98 | 147 | 196 | 245 | 294 | 343 | 393 | 441 | +---+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+---------+-----+---------+ | 8 | 128 | 192 | 256 | 320 | 384 | 448 | 512 | 576 | +---+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+---------+-----+---------+ | 9 | 168 | 243 | 324 | 405 | 486 | 567 | 648 |729[{25}]| +---+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+---------+-----+---------+ [Sidenote: How to prove the square root without or with a remainder.] The rote of the most quadrat conteyned{e} vndre the nombre p{ro}posed{e}. Therfor yf thow wilt p{ro}ve yf thow have wele do or no, Multiplie the digit last found{e} w{i}t{h} the vnder-double ož{er} vnder-doublis, and thow shalt fynde the same figures that thow haddest before; And so that nought be the [*Fol. 55.] residue. And yf thow have any residue, than w{i}t{h} the addicio{u}n ž{er}of that is res{er}ued{e} w{i}t{h}-out in thy table, thow shalt fynd{e} thi first figures as thow haddest them before, {et}c. [Headnote: Chapter XI. Extraction of Cube Root.] [Sidenote: Definition of a cubic number and a cube root. Mark off the places in threes. Find the first digit; treble it and place it under the next but one, and multiply by the digit. Then find the second digit. Multiply the first triplate and the second digit, twice by this digit. Subtract. Examples.] Heere folowith{e} the extraccio{u}n of rotis in cubik{e} nombres; wher-for me most se what is a nombre cubik{e}, and what is his roote, And what is the extraccio{u}n of a rote. A nombre cubik{e} it is, as it is before declared{e}, that cometh{e} of ledyng of any nombre twies in hym-self{e}, other ones in his quadrat. The rote of a nombre cubik{e} is the nombre that is twies had{e} in hy{m}-self{e}, or ones in his quadrat. Wher-thurgh{e} it is open, that eu{er}y nombre quadrat or cubik{e} have the same rote, as it is seid{e} before. And forto draw out the rote of a cubik{e}, It is first to fynd{e} že nombr{e} p{ro}posed{e} yf it be a cubik{e}; And yf it be not, than thow most make extraccio{u}n of his rote of the most cubik{e} vndre the nombre p{ro}posid{e} his rote found{e}. Therfor p{ro}posed{e} some nombre, whos cubical rote ž{o}u woldest draw out; First thow most compt the figures by fourthes, that is to sey in the place of thousand{es}; And vnder the last thousand{e} place, thow most fynde a digit, the which{e} lad{e} in hym-self cubikly puttith{e} a-way that žat is ou{er} his hede as in respect of hym, other as nygh{e} as thow maist. That done, thow most trebill{e} the digit, and that triplat is to be put vnder the .3. next figure toward{e} the right hond{e}, And the vnder-trebill{e} vnder the trebill{e}; Than me most fynd{e} a digit vndre the next figure bifore the triplat, the which{e} w{i}t{h} his vnder-trebill{e} had into a trebill{e}, aft{er}warde other vnder[trebille][{26}] had in his p{ro}duccio{u}n, putteth{e} a-way all{e} that is ou{er} it in regard{e} of[{27}] [the triplat. Then lade in hymself puttithe away that žat is over his hede as in respect of hym, other as nyghe as thou maist:] That done, thow most trebill{e} the digit ayene, and the triplat is to be sette vnder the next .3. figure as before, And the vnder-trebill{e} vnder the trebill{e}: and than most thow sette forward{e} the first triplat w{i}t{h} his vndre-trebill{e} by .2. differences. And than most thow fynde a digit vnder the next figure before the triplat, the which{e} with{e} his vnder-t{r}iplat had in his triplat afterward{e}, other vnder-treblis lad in p{ro}duct [*Fol. 55b] It sitteth{e} a-way a[l~l] that is ou{er} his hede in respect of the triplat than had in hym-self cubikly,[{28}] [[it setteth{e} a-way all{e} his respect]] or as nygh{e} as ye may. +----------------+--+-+-+-+-+-+---++--+-+-+-+-+--++----+-+--+-+--+ | Residuu{m} | | | | | | | 5 || | | | | | 4|| 1|0|1 |9| | +----------------+--+-+-+-+-+-+---++--+-+-+-+-+--++----+-+--+-+--+ | Cubicandu{s} | 8|3|6|5|4|3| 2 || 3|0|0|7|6| 7|| 1 1|6|6 |7| | +----------------+--+-+-+-+-+-+---++--+-+-+-+-+--++----+-+--+-+--+ | Triplum | | |6|0| | | || | | |1|8| || | |4 | | | +----------------+--+-+-+-+-+-+---++--+-+-+---+--++----+-+--+-+--+ | Subt{r}iplu{m} | 2| | |0| | |[3]|| | |6| | | 7|| 2| | |2| | +----------------+--+-+-+-+-+-+---++--+-+-+-+-+--++----+-+--+-+--+ [Sidenote: Continue this process till the first figure is reached. Examples. The residue. Special cases. Special case.] Nother me shall{e} not cesse of the fyndyng{e} of that digit, neither of his triplacio{u}n, než{er} of the triplat-is [{29}]anteriorac{i}o{u}n, that is to sey, settyng forward{e} by .2. differences, Ne therof the vndre-triple to be put vndre the triple, Nether of the multiplicacio{u}n ž{er}of, Neither of the subtraccio{u}n, till{e} it come to the first figure, vnder the which{e} is a digitall{e} nombre to be found{e}, the which{e} with{e} his vndre-treblis most be had{e} in tribles, After-ward{e} w{i}t{h}out vnder-treblis to be had{e} into produccio{u}n, settyng away all{e} that is ou{er} the hed{e} of the triplat nombre, After had into hymself{e} cubikly, and sette all{e}-way that is ou{er} hym. +------------------+---+---+---+---++---+---+---+---+---+ | To be cubiced{e} | 1 | 7 | 2 | 8 || 3 | 2 | 7 | 6 | 8 | +------------------+---+---+---+---++---+---+---+---+---+ | The triple | | | 3 | 2 || | | | 9 | | +------------------+---+---+---+---++---+---+---+---+---+ | The vnder triple | | | 1 | 2 || |[3]| | 3 | 3 | +------------------+---+---+---+---++---+---+---+---+---+ Also note wele that the p{ro}ducc{i}on comyng{e} of the ledyng of a digite found{e}[{30}] [[w{i}t{h} an vndre-triple / other of an vndre-triple in a triple or triplat is And after-ward{e} w{i}t{h} out vndre-triple other vndre-triplis in the p{ro}duct and ayene that p{ro}duct that cometh{e} of the ledyng{e} of a digit found{e} in hym-self{e} cubicall{e}]] me may adde to, and also w{i}t{h}-draw fro of the totall{e} nombre sette above that digit so found{e}.[{31}] [[as ther had be a divisio{u}n made as it is opened{e} before]] That done ought or nought most be the residue. If it be nought, It is open that the nombre p{ro}posed{e} was a cubik{e} nombre, And his rote a digit founde last w{i}t{h} the vnder-triples: If the rote therof wex bad{e} in hym-self{e}, and afterward{e} p{ro}duct they shall{e} make the first fig{ur}es. And yf ought be in residue, kepe that w{i}t{h}out in the table; and it is open{e} that the nombre was not a cubik{e}. but a digit last founde w{i}t{h} the vndirtriplis is rote of the most cubik{e} vndre the nombre p{ro}posed{e} conteyned{e}, the which{e} rote yf it be had{e} in hym-self{e}, And aft{er}ward{e} in a p{ro}duct of that shall{e} growe the most cubik{e} vndre the nombre p{ro}posed{e} conteyned{e}, And yf that be added{e} to a cubik{e} the residue res{er}ued{e} in the table, woll{e} make the same figures that ye had{e} first. [*Fol. 56.] And yf no digit after the anterioracio{u}n[{32}] may not be found{e}, than put ther{e} a cifre vndre a cifre vndir the third{e} figure, And put forward{e} že fig{ur}es. Note also wele that yf in the nombre p{ro}posed{e} ther ben no place of thowsand{es}, me most begynne vnder the first figure in the extraccio{u}n of the rote. some vsen forto distingue the nombre by threes, and ay begynne forto wirch{e} vndre the first of the last t{er}nary other unco{m}plete nombre, the which{e} maner of op{er}acio{u}n accordeth{e} w{i}t{h} that before. And this at this tyme suffiseth{e} in extraccio{u}n of nombres quadrat or cubik{es} {et}c. [Sidenote: Examples.] +-------------------+---+--+------+--+--+--+--++--+--+--+--+--+--+--+ | The residue | | | | | | | 0|| | | | | | 1| 1| +-------------------+---+--+------+--+--+--+--++--+--+--+--+--+--+--+ | The cubicand{us} | 8 | 0| 0 | 0| 0| 0| 0|| 8| 2| 4| 2| 4| 1| 9| +-------------------+---+--+------+--+--+--+--++--+--+--+--+--+--+--+ | The triple | | |[{33}]| 0| 0| | || | | 6| | | | | +-------------------+---+--+------+--+--+--+--++--+--+--+--+--+--+--+ | The vndert{r}iple |[2]| | | 0| 0| | || 2| | | 6| 2| | | +-------------------+---+--+------+--+--+--+--++--+--+--+--+--+--+--+ [Headnote: Table of Numbers, &c.] [Sidenote: A table of numbers; probably from the Abacus.] 1 2 3 4 5 6 one. x. an. hundred{e}/ a thowsand{e}/ x. thowsand{e}/ An hundred{e} 7 thowsand{e}/ A thowsand{e} tymes a thowsand{e}/ x. thousand{e} tymes a thousand{e}/ An hundred{e} thousand{e} tymes a thousand{e} A thousand{e} thousand{e} tymes a thousand{e}/ this is the x place {et}c. [Ende.] FOOTNOTES (The Art of Nombryng): [1: MS. Materiall{e}.] [2: MS. Formall{e}.] [3: 'the' in MS.] [4: 'be' in MS.] [5: 'and' in MS.] [6: 'is' in MS.] [7: 6 in MS.] [8: 0 in MS.] [9: 2 in MS.] [10: _sic._] [11: 'And' inserted in MS.] [12: '4 the' inserted in MS.] [13: 'to' in MS.] [14: 'that' repeated in MS.] [15: '1' in MS.] [16: Blank in MS.] [17: 'nought' in MS.] [18: 3 written for 2 in MS.] [19: 7 in MS.] [20: runs on in MS.] [21: 'so' in MS.] [22: 'nought' in MS.] [23: MS. adds here: 'wher-vpon{e} se the table in the next side of the next leef{e}.'] [24: 110 in MS.] [25: 0 in MS.] [26: double in MS.] [27: 'it hym-self{e}' in MS.] [28: MS. adds here: 'it setteth{e} a-way all{e} his respect.'] [29: 'aucterioracio{u}n' in MS.] [30: MS. adds here: 'w{i}t{h} an vndre-triple / other of an vndre-triple in a triple or triplat is And after-ward{e} w{i}t{h} out vndre-triple other vndre-triplis in the p{ro}duct and ayene that p{ro}duct that cometh{e} of the ledyng{e} of a digit found{e} in hym-self{e} cubicall{e}' /] [31: MS. adds here: 'as ther had be a divisio{u}n made as it is opened{e} before.'] [32: MS. anteriocacio{u}n.] [33: 4 in MS.] Accomptynge by counters. [Transcriber's Note: The original text was printed as a single continuous paragraph, with no break between speakers; all examples were shown inline. It has been broken up for this e-text.] [*116b] ¶ The seconde dialoge of accomptynge by counters. _Mayster._ Nowe that you haue learned the commen kyndes of Arithmetyke with the penne, you shall se the same art in cou{n}ters: whiche feate doth not only serue for them that can not write and rede, but also for them that can do bothe, but haue not at some tymes theyr penne or tables redye with them. This sorte is in two fourmes co{m}menly. The one by lynes, and the other without lynes: in that y^t hath lynes, the lynes do stande for the order of places: and in y^t that hath no lynes, there must be sette in theyr stede so many counters as shall nede, for eche lyne one, and they shall supplye the stede of the lynes. _S._ By examples I shuld better p{er}ceaue your meanynge. _M._ For example of the [*117a.] ly[*]nes: ----1-0-0-0-0-0-- ----1-0-0-0-0---- -X--1-0-0-0------ ----1-0-0-------- ----1-0---------- ----1------------ [Sidenote: Numeration.] Lo here you se .vi. lynes whiche stande for syxe places so that the nethermost standeth for y^e fyrst place, and the next aboue it, for the second: and so vpward tyll you come to the hyghest, which is the syxte lyne, and standeth for the syxte place. Now what is the valewe of euery place or lyne, you may perceaue by the figures whiche I haue set on them, which is accordynge as you learned before in the Numeration of figures by the penne: for the fyrste place is the place of vnities or ones, and euery counter set in that lyne betokeneth but one: {and} the seconde lyne is the place of 10, for euery counter there, standeth for 10. The thyrd lyne the place of hundredes: the fourth of thousandes: {and} so forth. _S._ Syr I do perceaue that the same order is here of lynes, as was in the other figures [*117b] by places, so that you shall not nede longer to stande about Numeration, excepte there be any other difference. _M._ Yf you do vndersta{n}de it, then how wyll you set 1543? _S._ Thus, as I suppose. ------- -X--1-- ----5-- ----4-- ----3-- _M._ You haue set y^e places truely, but your figures be not mete for this vse: for the metest figure in this behalfe, is the figure of a cou{n}ter round, as you se here, where I haue expressed that same summe. ------------- -X--o-------- o ------------- ----o-o-o-o-- ----o-o-o---- _S._ So that you haue not one figure for 2, nor 3, nor 4, and so forth, but as many digettes as you haue, you set in the lowest lyne: and for euery 10 you set one in the second line: and so of other. But I know not by what reason you set that one counter for 500 betwene two lynes. _M._ you shall remember this, that when so euer you nede to set downe 5, 50, or 500, or 5000, or so forth any other nomber, whose numerator [*118a] is 5, you shall set one counter for it, in the next space aboue the lyne that it hath his denomination of, as in this example of that 500, bycause the numerator is 5, it must be set in a voyd space: and bycause the denominator is hundred, I knowe that his place is the voyde space next aboue hundredes, that is to say, aboue the thyrd lyne. And farther you shall marke, that in all workynge by this sorte, yf you shall sette downe any summe betwene 4 and 10, for the fyrste parte of that nomber you shall set downe 5, & then so many counters more, as there reste no{m}bers aboue 5. And this is true bothe of digettes and articles. And for example I wyll set downe this su{m}me 287965, -X----------- ------o-o---- o ------o-o-o-- o -X----o-o---- o ----o-o-o-o-- o ----o-------- o ------------- which su{m}me yf you marke well, you nede none other exa{m}ples for to lerne the numeration of [*118b] this forme. But this shal you marke, that as you dyd in the other kynde of arithmetike, set a pricke in the places of thousa{n}des, in this worke you shall sette a starre, as you se here. [Headnote: Addition on the Counting Board.] [Sidenote: Addition.] _S._ Then I perceave numeration, but I praye you, howe shall I do in this arte to adde two summes or more together? _M._ The easyest way in this arte is, to adde but 2 su{m}mes at ones together: how be it you may adde more, as I wyll tell you anone. Therfore when you wyll adde two su{m}mes, you shall fyrst set downe one of them, it forseth not whiche, {and} then by it drawe a lyne crosse the other lynes. And afterward set downe the other su{m}me, so that that lyne may be betwene them, as yf you wolde adde 2659 to 8342, you must set your su{m}mes as you se -------------|----------- o | -X--o-o-o----|--o-o------ | o ----o-o-o----|--o-------- | o ----o-o-o-o--|----------- | o ----o-o------|--o-o-o-o-- here. And then yf you lyst, you [*119a] may adde the one to the other in the same place, or els you may adde them both together in a newe place: which waye, bycause it is moste playnest, I wyll showe you fyrst. Therfore wyl I begynne at the vnites, whiche in the fyrst su{m}me is but 2, {and} in y^e second su{m}me 9, that maketh 11, those do I take vp, and for them I set 11 in the new roume, thus, -------------|-------|------- o | | -X--o-o-o----|--o-o--|------- | o | ----o-o-o----|--o----|------- | o | ----o-o-o-o--|-------|-o----- | | -------------|-------|-o----- Then do I take vp all y^e articles vnder a hundred, which in the fyrst su{m}me are 40, and in the second summe 50, that maketh 90: or you may saye better, that in the fyrste summe there are 4 articles of 10, and in the seconde summe 5, which make 9, but then take hede that you sette them in theyr [*119b] ryght lynes as you se here. -----------|----------|------------- o | | -X--o-o-o--|--o-o-----|------------- | o | ----o-o-o--|--o-------|------------- | | o -----------|----------|--o-o-o-o-o-- | | -----------|----------|--o---------- Where I haue taken awaye 40 fro{m} the fyrste su{m}me, and 50 from y^e second, and in theyr stede I haue set 90 in the thyrde, whiche I haue set playnely y^t you myght well perceaue it: how be it seynge that 90 with the 10 that was in y^e thyrd roume all redy, doth make 100, I myghte better for those 6 cou{n}ters set 1 in the thyrde lyne, thus: ---------- -X-------- ----o----- ---------- ----o----- For it is all one summe as you may se, but it is beste, neuer to set 5 cou{n}ters in any line, for that may be done with 1 cou{n}ter in a hygher place. _S._ I iudge that good reaso{n}, for many are vnnedefull, where one wyll serue. _M._ Well, then [*120a] wyll I adde forth of hundredes: I fynde 3 in the fyrste summe, and 6 in the seconde, whiche make 900, them do I take vp {and} set in the thyrd roume where is one hundred all redy, to whiche I put 900, and it wyll be 1000, therfore I set one cou{n}ter in the fourth lyne for them all, as you se here. -----------|-------|-------- o | | -X--o-o-o--|--o-o--|--o----- | | -----------|-------|-------- | | -----------|-------|-------- | | -----------|-------|--o----- Then adde I y^e thousandes together, whiche in the fyrst su{m}me are 8000, {and} in y^e second 2000, that maketh 10000: them do I take vp fro{m} those two places, and for them I set one counter in the fyfte lyne, and then appereth as you se, to be 11001, for so many doth amount of the addition of 8342 to 2659. ----o----- -X--o----- ---------- ---------- ----o----- [*120b] _S._ Syr, this I do perceave: but how shall I set one su{m}me to an other, not chaungynge them to a thyrde place? _M._ Marke well how I do it: I wyll adde together 65436, and 3245, whiche fyrste I set downe thus. -------------|-------------- | o -------------|--o----------- | o -X--o-o-o----|-------------- | ----o-o------|--o-o-o-o----- | ----o-o-o-o--|--o-o-o------- o | o -------------|--o----------- Then do I begynne with the smalest, which in the fyrst summe is 5, that do I take vp, and wold put to the other 5 in the seconde summe, sauynge that two counters can not be set in a voyd place of 5, but for them bothe I must set 1 in the seconde lyne, which is the place of 10, therfore I take vp the 5 of the fyrst su{m}me, {and} the 5 of the seco{n}de, and for them I set 1 in the seco{n}d lyne, [*121a] as you se here. -------------|-------------- | o -------------|--o----------- | o -X--o-o-o----|-------------- | ----o-o------|--o-o-o-o----- | ----o-o-o-o--|--o-o-o-o----- | -------------|--o----------- Then do I lyke wayes take vp the 4 counters of the fyrste su{m}me {and} seconde lyne (which make 40) and adde them to the 4 counters of the same lyne, in the second su{m}me, and it maketh 80, But as I sayde I maye not conueniently set aboue 4 cou{n}ters in one lyne, therfore to those 4 that I toke vp in the fyrst su{m}me, I take one also of the seconde su{m}me, and then haue I taken vp 50, for whiche 5 counters I sette downe one in the space ouer y^e second lyne, as here doth appere. -----------|-------------- | o -----------|--o----------- | o -X--o-o-o--|-------------- | ----o-o----|--o-o-o-o----- | o -----------|--o-o-o------- | -----------|--o----------- [*121b.] and then is there 80, as well w^t those 4 counters, as yf I had set downe y^e other 4 also. Now do I take the 200 in the fyrste su{m}me, and adde them to the 400 in the seconde summe, and it maketh 600, therfore I take vp the 2 counters in the fyrste summe, and 3 of them in the seconde summe, and for them 5 I set 1 in y^e space aboue, thus. -----------|------------ | o -----------|--o--------- | o -X--o-o-o--|------------ | o -----------|--o--------- | o -----------|--o-o-o----- | -----------|--o--------- Then I take y^e 3000 in y^e fyrste su{m}me, vnto whiche there are none in the second summe agreynge, therfore I do onely remoue those 3 counters from the fyrste summe into the seconde, as here doth appere. ----|------------- | o ----|---o--------- | o -X--|---o-o-o----- | o ----|-o----------- | o ----|---o-o-o----- | ----|---o--------- [*122a.] And so you see the hole su{m}me, that amou{n}teth of the addytio{n} of 65436 with 3245 to be 6868[1]. And yf you haue marked these two exa{m}ples well, you nede no farther enstructio{n} in Addition of 2 only summes: but yf you haue more then two summes to adde, you may adde them thus. Fyrst adde two of them, and then adde the thyrde, and y^e fourth, or more yf there be so many: as yf I wolde adde 2679 with 4286 and 1391. Fyrste I adde the two fyrste summes thus. -------------|-----------|-------------- | | o -X--o-o------|--o-o-o-o--|--o----------- o | | o ----o--------|--o-o------|--o-o-o-o----- o | o | o ----o-o------|--o-o-o----|--o----------- o | o | o ----o-o-o-o--|--o--------|-------------- [*122b.] And then I adde the thyrde thereto thus. And so of more yf you haue them. -------------|-----------|------------ | o | o -X--o--------|--o--------|--o-o-o----- | o | ----o-o-o----|--o-o-o-o--|--o-o-o----- o | o | o ----o-o-o-o--|----o------|------------ | o | o ----o--------|-----------|--o--------- [Headnote: Subtraction on the Counting Board.] [Sidenote: Subtraction.] _S._ Nowe I thynke beste that you passe forth to Subtraction, except there be any wayes to examyn this maner of Addition, then I thynke that were good to be knowen nexte. _M._ There is the same profe here that is in the other Addition by the penne, I meane Subtraction, for that onely is a sure waye: but consyderynge that Subtraction must be fyrste knowen, I wyl fyrste teache you the arte of Subtraction, and that by this example: I wolde subtracte 2892 out of 8746. These summes must I set downe as I dyd in Addition: but here it is best [*116a (_sic_).] to set the lesser no{m}ber fyrste, thus. -------------|-------------- | o -X--o-o------|--o-o-o------- o | o ----o-o-o----|--o-o--------- o | ----o-o-o-o--|--o-o-o-o----- | o ----o-o------|--o----------- Then shall I begynne to subtracte the greatest nombres fyrste (contrary to the vse of the penne) y^t is the thousandes in this exa{m}ple: therfore I fynd amongest the thousandes 2, for which I withdrawe so many fro{m} the seconde summe (where are 8) and so remayneth there 6, as this exa{m}ple showeth. -------------+-------------- | o -+-----------+--o----------- o | o ----o-o-o----+--o-o--------- o | ----o-o-o-o--+--o-o-o-o----- | o ----o-o------+--o----------- Then do I lyke wayes with the hundredes, of whiche in the fyrste summe [*116b] I fynde 8, and is the seconde summe but 7, out of whiche I can not take 8, therfore thus muste I do: I muste loke how moche my summe dyffereth from 10, whiche I fynde here to be 2, then must I bate for my su{m}me of 800, one thousande, and set downe the excesse of hundredes, that is to saye 2, for so moche 100[0] is more then I shuld take vp. Therfore fro{m} the fyrste su{m}me I take that 800, and from the second su{m}me where are 6000, I take vp one thousande, and leue 5000; but then set I downe the 200 unto the 700 y^t are there all redye, and make them 900 thus. -------------+-------------- | o -+-----------+-------------- | o -------------+--o-o-o-o----- o | ----o-o-o-o--+--o-o-o-o----- | o ----o-o------+--o----------- Then come I to the articles of te{n}nes where in the fyrste su{m}me I fynde 90, [*117a] and in the seconde su{m}me but only 40: Now consyderyng that 90 can not be bated from 40, I loke how moche y^t 90 doth dyffer from the next summe aboue it, that is 100 (or elles whiche is all to one effecte, I loke how moch 9 doth dyffer fro{m} 10) {and} I fynd it to be 1, then in the stede of that 90, I do take from the second summe 100: but consyderynge that it is 10 to moche, I set downe 1 in y^e nexte lyne beneth for it, as you se here. ---------+------------ | o -+-------+------------ | o ---------+--o-o-o----- | o ---------+------------ | o ----o-o--+--o--------- Sauynge that here I haue set one counter in y^e space in stede of 5 in y^e nexte lyne. And thus haue I subtracted all saue two, which I must bate from the 6 in the second summe, and there wyll remayne 4, thus. ----+-------------- | o -+--+-------------- | o ----+--o-o-o------- | o ----+-------------- | ----+--o-o-o-o----- So y^t yf I subtracte 2892 fro{m} 8746, the remayner wyll be 5854, [*117b] And that this is truely wrought, you maye proue by Addition: for yf you adde to this remayner the same su{m}me that you dyd subtracte, then wyll the formar su{m}me 8746 amount agayne. _S._ That wyll I proue: and fyrst I set the su{m}me that was subtracted, which was 2892, {and} the{n} the remayner 5854, thus. --------------+-------------- | o -||--o-o------+-------------- o | o -----o-o-o----+--o-o-o------- o | o -----o-o-o-o--+-------------- | -----o-o------+--o-o-o-o----- Then do I adde fyrst y^e 2 to 4, whiche maketh 6, so take I vp 5 of those counters, and in theyr stede I sette 1 in the space, as here appereth. --------------+------------ | o -||--o-o------+------------ o | o -----o-o-o----+--o-o-o----- o | o -----o-o-o-o--+------------ | o --------------+--o--------- [*118a] Then do I adde the 90 nexte aboue to the 50, and it maketh 140, therfore I take vp those 6 counters, and for them I sette 1 to the hundredes in y^e thyrde lyne, {and} 4 in y^e second lyne, thus. ------------+-------------- | o -||--o-o----+-------------- o | o -----o-o-o--+--o-o-o-o----- | ------------+--o-o-o-o----- | o ------------+----o--------- Then do I come to the hundredes, of whiche I fynde 8 in the fyrst summe, and 9 in y^e second, that maketh 1700, therfore I take vp those 9 counters, and in theyr stede I sette 1 in the .iiii. lyne, and 1 in the space nexte beneth, and 2 in the thyrde lyne, as you se here. ----------+-------------- | o -||--o-o--+--o----------- | o ----------+--o-o--------- | ----------+--o-o-o-o----- | o ----------+--o----------- Then is there lefte in the fyrste summe but only 2000, whiche I shall take vp from thence, and set [*118b] in the same lyne in y^e second su{m}me, to y^e one y^t is there all redy: {and} then wyll the hole su{m}me appere (as you may wel se) to be 8746, which was y^e fyrst grosse summe, {and} therfore I do perceaue, that I hadde well subtracted before. And thus you may se how Subtraction maye be tryed by Addition. ----+-------------- | o -X--+--o-o-o------- | o ----+--o-o--------- | ----+--o-o-o-o----- | o ----+----o--------- _S._ I perceaue the same order here w^t cou{n}ters, y^t I lerned before in figures. _M._ Then let me se howe can you trye Addition by Subtraction. _S._ Fyrste I wyl set forth this exa{m}ple of Additio{n} where I haue added 2189 to 4988, and the hole su{m}me appereth to be 7177, --------------+-----------+---------- | | o -||--o-o------+--o-o-o-o--+--o-o----- | o | -----o--------+--o-o-o-o--+--o------- o | o | o -----o-o-o----+--o-o-o----+--o-o----- o | o | o -----o-o-o-o--+--o-o-o----+--o-o----- [*119a] Nowe to trye whether that su{m}me be well added or no, I wyll subtract one of the fyrst two su{m}mes from the thyrd, and yf I haue well done y^e remayner wyll be lyke that other su{m}me. As for example: I wyll subtracte the fyrste summe from the thyrde, whiche I set thus in theyr order. --------------+---------- | o -||--o-o------+--o-o----- | -----o--------+--o------- o | o -----o-o-o----+--o-o----- o | o -----o-o-o-o--+--o-o----- Then do I subtract 2000 of the fyrste summe fro{m} y^e second su{m}me, and then remayneth there 5000 thus. -------------+---------- | o -X-----------+----------- | ----o--------+--o------- o | o ----o-o-o----+--o-o----- o | o ----o-o-o-o--+--o-o----- Then in the thyrd lyne, I subtract y^e 100 of the fyrste summe, fro{m} the second su{m}me, where is onely 100 also, and then in y^e thyrde lyne resteth nothyng. Then in the second lyne with his space ouer hym, I fynde 80, which I shuld subtract [*119b] from the other su{m}me, then seyng there are but only 70 I must take it out of some hygher summe, which is here only 5000, therfore I take vp 5000, and seyng that it is to moch by 4920, I sette downe so many in the seconde roume, whiche with the 70 beynge there all redy do make 4990, & then the summes doth stande thus. --------------+-------------- | -||-----------+--o-o-o-o----- | o --------------+--o-o-o-o----- | o --------------+--o-o-o-o----- o | o -----o-o-o-o--+--o-o--------- Yet remayneth there in the fyrst su{m}me 9, to be bated from the second summe, where in that place of vnities dothe appere only 7, then I muste bate a hygher su{m}me, that is to saye 10, but seynge that 10 is more then 9 (which I shulde abate) by 1, therfore shall I take vp one counter from the seconde lyne, {and} set downe the same in the fyrst [*120a] or lowest lyne, as you se here. -----+-------------- | -||--+--o-o-o-o----- | o -----+--o-o-o-o----- | o -----+--o-o-o------- | o -----+--o-o-o------- And so haue I ended this worke, {and} the su{m}me appereth to be y^e same, whiche was y^e seconde summe of my addition, and therfore I perceaue, I haue wel done. _M._ To stande longer about this, it is but folye: excepte that this you maye also vnderstande, that many do begynne to subtracte with counters, not at the hyghest su{m}me, as I haue taught you, but at the nethermoste, as they do vse to adde: and when the summe to be abatyd, in any lyne appeareth greater then the other, then do they borowe one of the next hygher roume, as for example: yf they shuld abate 1846 from 2378, they set y^e summes thus. --------------+------------ | -||--o--------+--o-o------- o | -----o-o-o----+--o-o-o----- | o -----o-o-o-o--+--o-o------- o | o -----o--------+--o-o-o----- [*120b] And fyrste they take 6 whiche is in the lower lyne, and his space from 8 in the same roumes, in y^e second su{m}me, and yet there remayneth 2 counters in the lowest lyne. Then in the second lyne must 4 be subtracte from 7, and so remayneth there 3. Then 8 in the thyrde lyne and his space, from 3 of the second summe can not be, therfore do they bate it from a hygher roume, that is, from 1000, and bycause that 1000 is to moch by 200, therfore must I sette downe 200 in the thyrde lyne, after I haue taken vp 1000 from the fourth lyne: then is there yet 1000 in the fourth lyne of the fyrst summe, whiche yf I withdrawe from the seconde summe, then doth all y^e figures stande in this order. -----+------------ | -||--+------------ | o -----+------------ | -----+--o-o-o----- | -----+--o-o------- So that (as you se) it differeth not greatly whether you begynne subtractio{n} at the hygher lynes, or at [*121a] the lower. How be it, as some menne lyke the one waye beste, so some lyke the other: therfore you now knowyng bothe, may vse whiche you lyst. [Headnote: Multiplication by Counters.] [Sidenote: Multiplication.] But nowe touchynge Multiplicatio{n}: you shall set your no{m}bers in two roumes, as you dyd in those two other kyndes, but so that the multiplier be set in the fyrste roume. Then shall you begyn with the hyghest no{m}bers of y^e seconde roume, and multiply them fyrst after this sort. Take that ouermost lyne in your fyrst workynge, as yf it were the lowest lyne, setting on it some mouable marke, as you lyste, and loke how many counters be in hym, take them vp, and for them set downe the hole multyplyer, so many tymes as you toke vp counters, reckenyng, I saye that lyne for the vnites: {and} when you haue so done with the hygheest no{m}ber then come to the nexte lyne beneth, {and} do euen so with it, and so with y^e next, tyll you haue done all. And yf there be any nomber in a space, then for it [*121b] shall you take y^e multiplyer 5 tymes, and then must you recken that lyne for the vnites whiche is nexte beneth that space: or els after a shorter way, you shall take only halfe the multyplyer, but then shall you take the lyne nexte aboue that space, for the lyne of vnites: but in suche workynge, yf chau{n}ce your multyplyer be an odde nomber, so that you can not take the halfe of it iustly, then muste you take the greater halfe, and set downe that, as if that it were the iuste halfe, and farther you shall set one cou{n}ter in the space beneth that line, which you recken for the lyne of vnities, or els only remoue forward the same that is to be multyplyed. _S._ Yf you set forth an example hereto I thynke I shal perceaue you. _M._ Take this exa{m}ple: I wold multiply 1542 by 365, therfore I set y^e nombers thus. ------------+-------------- | -||---------+--o----------- | o -----o-o-o--+-------------- o | -----o------+--o-o-o-o----- o | ------------+--o-o--------- [*122a] Then fyrste I begynne at the 1000 in y^e hyghest roume, as yf it were y^e fyrst place, & I take it vp, settynge downe for it so often (that is ones) the multyplyer, which is 365, thus, as you se here: -----------+-----------+------------ | | -----------+-----------+--o-o-o----- | | o -----------+-----------+--o--------- | | o -X---------+-----------+------------ [<-] | o | ----o-o-o--+-----------+------------ o | | ----o------+--o-o-o-o--+------------ o | | -----------+--o-o------+------------ where for the one counter taken vp from the fourth lyne, I haue sette downe other 6, whiche make y^e su{m}me of the multyplyer, reckenynge that fourth lyne, as yf it were the fyrste: whiche thyng I haue marked by the hand set at the begynnyng of y^e same, _S._ I perceaue this well: for in dede, this summe that you haue set downe is 365000, for so moche doth amount [*122b] of 1000, multiplyed by 365. _M._ Well the{n} to go forth, in the nexte space I fynde one counter which I remoue forward but take not vp, but do (as in such case I must) set downe the greater halfe of my multiplier (seyng it is an odde no{m}ber) which is 182, {and} here I do styll let that fourth place stand, as yf it were y^e fyrst: ------------+-----------+--o-o-o--+--o--------- | | o | o ------------+-----------+--o------+--o-o-o----- | | o | -||---------+-----------+---------+--o-o------- [<-] | | | o -----o-o-o--+-----------+---------+------------ o | | | -----o------+--o-o-o-o--+---------+------------ o | | | ------------+--o-o------+---------+------------ as in this fourme you se, where I haue set this multiplycatio{n} with y^e other: but for the ease of your vndersta{n}dynge, I haue set a lytell lyne betwene them: now shulde they both in one su{m}me stand thus. ------------+-----------+--o-o-o-o-o----- | | ------------+-----------+--o-o-o-o------- | | o -||---------+-----------+--o-o----------- [<-] | | o -----o-o-o--+-----------+---------------- o | | -----o------+--o-o-o-o--+---------------- o | | ------------+--o-o------+---------------- [*123a] Howe be it an other fourme to multyplye suche cou{n}ters i{n} space is this: Fyrst to remoue the fynger to the lyne nexte benethe y^e space, {and} then to take vp y^e cou{n}ter, {and} to set downe y^e multiplyer .v. tymes, as here you se. ---------+---------+-o-o-o-+------+------+------+------+------+- | | o | | | | | | ---------+---------+-o-----+o-o-o-+o-o-o-+o-o-o-+o-o-o-+o-o-o-+- | | o | o | o | o | o | o | ---------+---------+-------+o-----+------+o-----+o-----+o-----+- | | | o | o | o | o | o | [->]-X-o-o-o-+---------+-------+------+------+------+------+------+- o | | | | | | | | ---o-----+-o-o-o-o-+-------+------+------+------+------+------+- o | | | | | | | | ---------+-o-o-----+-------+------+------+------+------+------+- Which su{m}mes yf you do adde together into one su{m}me, you shal p{er}ceaue that it wyll be y^e same y^t appeareth of y^e other worki{n}g before, so that [*123b] bothe sortes are to one entent, but as the other is much shorter, so this is playner to reason, for suche as haue had small exercyse in this arte. Not withstandynge you maye adde them in your mynde before you sette them downe, as in this exa{m}ple, you myghte haue sayde 5 tymes 300 is 1500, {and} 5 tymes 60 is 300, also 5 tymes 5 is 25, whiche all put together do make 1825, which you maye at one tyme set downe yf you lyste. But nowe to go forth, I must remoue the hand to the nexte counters, whiche are in the second lyne, and there must I take vp those 4 counters, settynge downe for them my multiplyer 4 tymes, whiche thynge other I maye do at 4 tymes seuerally, or elles I may gather that hole summe in my mynde fyrste, and then set it downe: as to saye 4 tymes 300 is 1200: 4 tymes 60 are 240: and 4 tymes 5 make 20: y^t is in all 1460, y^t shall I set downe also: as here you se. o -----------+-------+-----------+-------------- | | | -----------+-------+--o-o-o-o--+--o----------- | | o | -X---------+-------+--o-o------+--o-o-o-o----- | | o | o ----o-o-o--+-------+-----------+--o----------- o | | | [->] ----o------+-------+-----------+-------------- o | | | -----------+--o-o--+-----------+-------------- [*124a] whiche yf I ioyne in one summe with the formar nombers, it wyll appeare thus. o ---------+-------+---------- | | o ---------+-------+--o------- | | ---------+-------+--o-o----- | | --o-o-o--+-------+-o-------- o | | [->] --o------+-------+---------- o | | ---------+--o-o--+---------- Then to ende this multiplycation, I remoue the fynger to the lowest lyne, where are onely 2, them do I take vp, and in theyr stede do I set downe twyse 365, that is 730, for which I set [*124b] one in the space aboue the thyrd lyne for 500, and 2 more in the thyrd lyne with that one that is there all redye, and the reste in theyr order, {and} so haue I ended the hole summe thus. o ---------+-----+------------ | | o ---------+-----+--o--------- | | ---------+-----+--o-o------- | | o --o-o-o--+-----+--o-o-o----- o | | --o------+-----+--o-o-o----- o | | ---------+-----+------------ Wherby you se, that 1542 (which is the nomber of yeares syth Ch[r]ystes incarnation) beyng multyplyed by 365 (which is the nomber of dayes in one yeare) dothe amounte vnto 562830, which declareth y^e no{m}ber of daies sith Chrystes incarnatio{n} vnto the ende of 1542[{1}] yeares. (besyde 385 dayes and 12 houres for lepe yeares). _S._ Now wyll I proue by an other exa{m}ple, as this: 40 labourers (after 6 d. y^e day for eche man) haue wrought 28 dayes, I wold [*125a] know what theyr wages doth amou{n}t vnto: In this case muste I worke doublely: fyrst I must multyplye the nomber of the labourers by y^e wages of a man for one day, so wyll y^e charge of one daye amount: then secondarely shall I multyply that charge of one daye, by the hole nomber of dayes, {and} so wyll the hole summe appeare: fyrst therefore I shall set the su{m}mes thus. ------+-------------- | ------+-------------- | ------+-------------- | ------+--o-o-o-o----- o | --o---+-------------- Where in the fyrste space is the multyplyer (y^t is one dayes wages for one man) {and} in the second space is set the nomber of the worke men to be multyplyed: the{n} saye I, 6 tymes 4 (reckenynge that second lyne as the lyne of vnites) maketh 24, for whiche summe I shulde set 2 counters in the thyrde lyne, and 4 in the seconde, therfore do I set 2 in the thyrde lyne, and let the 4 stand styll in the seconde lyne, thus.[*125b] -----+-------------- | -----+-------------- | -----+--o-o--------- | -----+--o-o-o-o----- | -----+-------------- So apwereth the hole dayes wages to be 240d“. that is 20 s. Then do I multiply agayn the same summe by the no{m}ber of dayes and fyrste I sette the nombers, thus. ---------+-------------- | ---------+-------------- | ---------+--o-o--------- | --o-o----+--o-o-o-o----- o | --o-o-o--+------------- The{n} bycause there are counters in dyuers lynes, I shall begynne with the hyghest, and take them vp, settynge for them the multyplyer so many tymes, as I toke vp counters, y^t is twyse, then wyll y^e su{m}me stande thus. -----+-------------- | o -----+-------------- | o -----+--o----------- | -----+--o-o-o-o----- | -----+-------------- Then come I to y^e seconde lyne, and take vp those 4 cou{n}ters, settynge for them the multiplyer foure tymes, so wyll the hole summe appeare thus.[*126a] -----+---------- | o -----+--o------- | o -----+--o-o----- | -----+--o-o----- | -----+---------- So is the hole wages of 40 workeme{n}, for 28 dayes (after 6d“. eche daye for a man) 6720d“. that is 560 s. or 28 l'i. [Headnote: Division on the Counting Board.] [Sidenote: Diuision.] _M._ Now if you wold proue Multiplycatio{n}, the surest way is by Dyuision: therfore wyll I ouer passe it tyll I haue taught you y^e arte of Diuision, whiche you shall worke thus. Fyrste sette downe the Diuisor for feare of forgettynge, and then set the nomber that shalbe deuided, at y^e ryghte syde, so farre from the diuisor, that the quotient may be set betwene them: as for exa{m}ple: Yf 225 shepe cost 45 l'i. what dyd euery shepe cost? To knowe this, I shulde diuide the hole summe, that is 45 l'i. by 225, but that can not be, therfore must I fyrste reduce that 45 l'i. into a lesser denomination, as into shyllynges: then I multiply 45 by 20, and it is 900, that summe shall I diuide by the no{m}ber of [*126b] shepe, whiche is 225, these two nombers therfore I sette thus. -------+-----+-------------- | | -------+-----+-------------- | | o --o-o--+-----+--o-o-o-o----- | | --o-o--+-----+-------------- o | | -------+-----+-------------- Then begynne I at the hyghest lyne of the diuident, and seke how often I may haue the diuisor therin, and that maye I do 4 tymes, then say I, 4 tymes 2 are 8, whyche yf I take from 9, there resteth but 1, thus -------+-----------+-------- | | -------+-----------+-------- | | --o-o--+-----------+--o----- | | --o-o--+-----------+-------- o | | -------+--o-o-o-o--+-------- And bycause I founde the diuisor 4 tymes in the diuidente, I haue set (as you se) 4 in the myddle roume, which [*127a] is the place of the quotient: but now must I take the reste of the diuisor as often out of the remayner: therfore come I to the seconde lyne of the diuisor, sayeng 2 foure tymes make 8, take 8 from 10, {and} there resteth 2, thus. ----------+-----------+---------- | | -||-------+-----------+---------- | | -----o-o--+-----------+---------- | | -----o-o--+-----------+--o-o----- o | | ----------+--o-o-o-o--+---------- Then come I to the lowest nomber, which is 5, and multyply it 4 tymes, so is it 20, that take I from 20, and there remayneth nothynge, so that I se my quotient to be 4, whiche are in valewe shyllynges, for so was the diuident: and therby I knowe, that yf 225 shepe dyd coste 45 l'i. euery shepe coste 4 s. _S._ This can I do, as you shall perceaue by this exa{m}ple: Yf 160 sowldyars do spende euery moneth 68 l'i. what spendeth eche man? Fyrst [*127b] bycause I can not diuide the 68 by 160, therfore I wyll turne the pou{n}des into pennes by multiplicacio{n}, so shall there be 16320 d“. Nowe muste I diuide this su{m}me by the nomber of sowldyars, therfore I set the{m} i{n} order, thus. ---------+-----+--o--------- | | o -||------+-----+--o--------- | | -----o---+-----+--o-o-o----- o | | -----o---+-----+--o-o------- | | ---------+-----+------------ Then begyn I at the hyghest place of the diuidente, sekynge my diuisor there, whiche I fynde ones, Therfore set I 1 in the nether lyne. _M._ Not in the nether line of the hole summe, but in the nether lyne of that worke, whiche is the thyrde lyne. _S._ So standeth it with reason. _M._ Then thus do they stande.[*128a] ---------+-----+------------ | | -||------+-----+------------ | | -----o---+--o--+--o-o-o----- o | | -----o---+-----+--o-o------- | | ---------+-----+------------ Then seke I agayne in the reste, how often I may fynde my diuisor, and I se that in the 300 I myghte fynde 100 thre tymes, but then the 60 wyll not be so often founde in 20, therfore I take 2 for my quotient: then take I 100 twyse from 300, and there resteth 100, out of whiche with the 20 (that maketh 120) I may take 60 also twyse, and then standeth the nombers thus, ---------+-------+----- | | -||------+-------+----- | | -----o---+--o----+----- o | | -----o---+-------+----- | | ---------+--o-o--+----- [*128b] where I haue sette the quotient 2 in the lowest lyne: So is euery sowldyars portion 102 d“. that is 8 s. 6 d“. _M._ But yet bycause you shall perceaue iustly the reason of Diuision, it shall be good that you do set your diuisor styll agaynst those nombres fro{m} whiche you do take it: as by this example I wyll declare. Yf y^e purchace of 200 acres of ground dyd coste 290 l'i. what dyd one acre coste? Fyrst wyl I turne the poundes into pennes, so wyll there be 69600 d“· Then in settynge downe these nombers I shall do thus. ---------+-----+-------------- | | o ----o-o--+-----+--o----------- | | o -X-------+-----+--o-o-o-o----- | | o ---------+-----+--o----------- | | ---------+-----+-------------- | | ---------+-----+-------------- Fyrst set the diuident on the ryghte hande as it oughte, and then [*129a] the diuisor on the lefte hande agaynst those nombers, fro{m} which I entende to take hym fyrst as here you se, wher I haue set the diuisor two lynes hygher the{n} is theyr owne place. _S._ This is lyke the order of diuision by the penne. _M._ Truth you say, and nowe must I set y^e quotient of this worke in the thyrde lyne, for that is the lyne of vnities in respecte to the diuisor in this worke. Then I seke howe often the diuisor maye be founde in the diuident, {and} that I fynde 3 tymes, then set I 3 in the thyrde lyne for the quotient, and take awaye that 60000 fro{m} the diuident, and farther I do set the diuisor one line lower, as yow se here. ----------+---------+-------------- | | o -||--o-o--+---------+--o-o-o-o----- | | o ----------+--o-o-o--+----o--------- | | ----------+---------+-------------- | | ----------+---------+-------------- [*129b] And then seke I how often the diuisor wyll be taken from the nomber agaynste it, whiche wyll be 4 tymes and 1 remaynynge. _S._ But what yf it chaunce that when the diuisor is so remoued, it can not be ones taken out of the diuident agaynste it? _M._ Then must the diuisor be set in an other line lower. _S._ So was it in diuision by the penne, and therfore was there a cypher set in the quotient: but howe shall that be noted here? _M._ Here nedeth no token, for the lynes do represente the places: onely loke that you set your quotient in that place which standeth for vnities in respecte of the diuisor: but now to returne to the example, I fynde the diuisor 4 tymes in the diuidente, and 1 remaynynge, for 4 tymes 2 make 8, which I take from 9, and there resteth 1, as this figure sheweth: ----------+-----------+--------- | | -||--o-o--+-----------+--o------ | | o ----------+--o-o-o----+--o------ | | ----------+--o-o-o-o--+--------- | | ----------+-----------+--------- and in the myddle space for the quotient I set 4 in the seconde lyne, whiche is in this worke the place of vnities.[*130a] Then remoue I y^e diuisor to the next lower line, and seke how often I may haue it in the dyuident, which I may do here 8 tymes iust, and nothynge remayne, as in this fourme, ----------+-----------+----- | | -||--o-o--+-----------+----- | | ----------+--o-o-o----+----- | | ----------+--o-o-o-o--+----- | o | ----------+--o-o-o----+----- where you may se that the hole quotient is 348 d“, that is 29 s. wherby I knowe that so moche coste the purchace of one aker. _S._ Now resteth the profes of Multiplycatio{n}, and also of Diuisio{n}. _M._ Ther best profes are eche [*130b] one by the other, for Multyplication is proued by Diuision, and Diuision by Multiplycation, as in the worke by the penne you learned. _S._ Yf that be all, you shall not nede to repete agayne that, y^t was sufficye{n}tly taughte all redye: and excepte you wyll teache me any other feate, here maye you make an ende of this arte I suppose. _M._ So wyll I do as touchynge hole nomber, and as for broken nomber, I wyll not trouble your wytte with it, tyll you haue practised this so well, y^t you be full perfecte, so that you nede not to doubte in any poynte that I haue taught you, and thenne maye I boldly enstructe you in y^e arte of fractions or broken no{m}ber, wherin I wyll also showe you the reasons of all that you haue nowe learned. But yet before I make an ende, I wyll showe you the order of co{m}men castyng, wher in are bothe pennes, shyllynges, and poundes, procedynge by no grounded reason, but onely by a receaued [*131a] fourme, and that dyuersly of dyuers men: for marchau{n}tes vse one fourme, and auditors an other: [Headnote: Merchants' Casting Counters.] [Sidenote: Merchants' casting.] But fyrste for marchauntes fourme marke this example here, o o o o o o o o o o o o o o o o o o o o o o in which I haue expressed this summe 198 l'i.[{2}] 19 s. 11 d“. So that you maye se that the lowest lyne serueth for pe{n}nes, the next aboue for shyllynges, the thyrde for poundes, and the fourth for scores of pou{n}des. And farther you maye se, that the space betwene pennes and shyllynges may receaue but one counter (as all other spaces lyke wayes do) and that one standeth in that place for 6 d“. Lyke wayes betwene the shyllynges {and} the pou{n}des, one cou{n}ter standeth for 10 s. And betwene the poundes and 20 l'i. one counter standeth for 10 pou{n}des. But besyde those you maye see at the left syde of shyllynges, that one counter standeth alone, {and} betokeneth 5 s. [*131b] So agaynste the poundes, that one cou{n}ter standeth for 5 l'i. And agaynst the 20 poundes, the one counter standeth for 5 score pou{n}des, that is 100 l'i. so that euery syde counter is 5 tymes so moch as one of them agaynst whiche he standeth. [Sidenote: Auditors' casting.] Now for the accompt of auditors take this example. o o o o o o o o o o o o o o o o o o o o o o where I haue expressed y^e same su{m}me 198 l'i. 19 s. 11 d“. But here you se the pe{n}nes stande toward y^e ryght hande, and the other encreasynge orderly towarde the lefte hande. Agayne you maye se, that auditours wyll make 2 lynes (yea and more) for pennes, shyllynges, {and} all other valewes, yf theyr summes extende therto. Also you se, that they set one counter at the ryght ende of eche rowe, whiche so set there standeth for 5 of that roume: and on [*132a] the lefte corner of the rowe it sta{n}deth for 10, of y^e same row. But now yf you wold adde other subtracte after any of both those sortes, yf you marke y^e order of y^t other feate which I taught you, you may easely do the same here without moch teachynge: for in Additio{n} you must fyrst set downe one su{m}me and to the same set the other orderly, and lyke maner yf you haue many: but in Subtraction you must sette downe fyrst the greatest summe, and from it must you abate that other euery denominatio{n} from his dewe place. _S._ I do not doubte but with a lytell practise I shall attayne these bothe: but how shall I multiply and diuide after these fourmes? _M._ You can not duely do none of both by these sortes, therfore in suche case, you must resort to your other artes. _S._ Syr, yet I se not by these sortes how to expresse hu{n}dreddes, yf they excede one hundred, nother yet thousandes. _M._ They that vse such accomptes that it excede 200 [*132b] in one summe, they sette no 5 at the lefte hande of the scores of poundes, but they set all the hundredes in an other farther rowe {and} 500 at the lefte hand therof, and the thousandes they set in a farther rowe yet, {and} at the lefte syde therof they sette the 5000, and in the space ouer they sette the 10000, and in a hygher rowe 20000, whiche all I haue expressed in this exa{m}ple, o o o o o o o o o o o o o o o o o o o o o o o o o o o o o o which is 97869 l'i. 12 s. 9 d“ ob. q. for I had not told you before where, nother how you shuld set downe farthynges, which (as you se here) must be set in a voyde space sydelynge beneth the pennes: for q one counter: for ob. 2 counters: for ob. q. 3 counters: {and} more there can not be, for 4 farthynges [*133a] do make 1 d“. which must be set in his dewe place. [Headnote: Auditors' Casting Counters.] And yf you desyre y^e same summe after audytors maner, lo here it is. o o o o o o o o o o o o o o o o o o o o o o o o o o o o o o But in this thyng, you shall take this for suffycyent, and the reste you shall obserue as you maye se by the working of eche sorte: for the dyuers wittes of men haue inuented dyuers and sundry wayes almost vnnumerable. But one feate I shall teache you, whiche not only for the straungenes and secretnes is moche pleasaunt, but also for the good co{m}moditie of it ryghte worthy to be well marked. This feate hath ben vsed aboue 2000 yeares at the leaste, and yet was it neuer come{n}ly knowen, especyally in Englysshe it was neuer taughte yet. This is the arte of nombrynge on the hand, with diuers gestures of the fyngers, expressynge any summe conceaued in the [*133b] mynde. And fyrst to begynne, yf you wyll expresse any summe vnder 100, you shall expresse it with your lefte hande: and from 100 vnto 10000, you shall expresse it with your ryght hande, as here orderly by this table folowynge you may perceaue. +¶ Here foloweth the table of the arte of the hande+ The arte of nombrynge by the hande. [Transcriber's Note: Footnote 3 reads: "Bracket ([) denotes new paragraph in original." For this e-text, the brackets have been omitted in favor of restoring the paragraph breaks. Changes of speaker (M, S) are also marked by paragraphs, as in the previous selection. The illustration includes the printed page number 134; there is therefore no sidenote *134a. The sidenote for "4" is missing.] [Illustration: (Numbers as described in text)] [Sidenote: 1] [*134b] In which as you may se 1 is expressed by y^e lyttle fynger of y^e lefte hande closely and harde croked. [Sidenote: 2] [{3}]2 is declared by lyke bowynge of the weddynge fynger (whiche is the nexte to the lyttell fynger) together with the lytell fynger. [Sidenote: 3] 3 is signified by the myddle fynger bowed in lyke maner, with those other two. 4 is declared by the bowyng of the myddle fynger and the rynge fynger, or weddynge fynger, with the other all stretched forth. [Sidenote: 5, 6] 5 is represented by the myddle fynger onely bowed. And 6 by the weddynge fynger only crooked: and this you may marke in these a certayne order. But now 7, 8, and 9, are expressed w{i}t{h} the bowynge of the same fyngers as are 1, 2, and 3, but after an other fourme. [Sidenote: 7] For 7 is declared by the bowynge of the lytell fynger, as is 1, saue that for 1 the fynger is clasped in, harde {and} [*135a] rounde, but for to expresse 7, you shall bowe the myddle ioynte of the lytell fynger only, and holde the other ioyntes streyght. _S._ Yf you wyll geue me leue to expresse it after my rude maner, thus I vnderstand your meanyng: that 1 is expressed by crookynge in the lyttell fynger lyke the head of a bysshoppes bagle: and 7 is declared by the same fynger bowed lyke a gybbet. _M._ So I perceaue, you vnderstande it. [Sidenote: 8] Then to expresse 8, you shall bowe after the same maner both the lyttell fynger and the rynge fynger. [Sidenote: 9, 10] And yf you bowe lyke wayes with them the myddle fynger, then doth it betoken 9. Now to expresse 10, you shall bowe your fore fynger rounde, and set the ende of it on the hyghest ioynte of the thombe. [Sidenote: 20] And for to expresse 20, you must set your fyngers streyght, and the ende of your thombe to the partitio{n} of the [*135b] fore moste and myddle fynger. [Sidenote: 30] 30 is represented by the ioynynge together of y^e headdes of the foremost fynger and the thombe. [Sidenote: 40] 40 is declared by settynge of the thombe crossewayes on the foremost fynger. [Sidenote: 50] 50 is signified by ryght stretchyng forth of the fyngers ioyntly, and applyenge of the thombes ende to the partition of the myddle fynger {and} the rynge fynger, or weddynge fynger. [Sidenote: 60] 60 is formed by bendynge of the thombe croked and crossynge it with the fore fynger. [Sidenote: 70] 70 is expressed by the bowynge of the foremost fynger, and settynge the ende of the thombe between the 2 foremost or hyghest ioyntes of it. [Sidenote: 80] 80 is expressed by settynge of the foremost fynger crossewayes on the thombe, so that 80 dyffereth thus fro{m} 40, that for 80 the forefynger is set crosse on the thombe, and for 40 the thombe is set crosse ouer y^e forefinger. [Sidenote: 90] [*136a] 90 is signified, by bendynge the fore fynger, and settyng the ende of it in the innermost ioynte of y^e thombe, that is euen at the foote of it. And thus are all the no{m}bers ended vnder 100. [Sidenote: 11, 12, 13, 21, 22, 23] _S._ In dede these be all the nombers fro{m} 1 to 10, {and} then all the tenthes within 100, but this teacyed me not how to expresse 11, 12, 13, {et}c. 21, 22, 23, {et}c. and such lyke. _M._ You can lytell vnderstande, yf you can not do that without teachynge: what is 11? is it not 10 and 1? then expresse 10 as you were taught, and 1 also, and that is 11: and for 12 expresse 10 and 2: for 23 set 20 and 3: and so for 68 you muste make 60 and there to 8: and so of all other sortes. [Sidenote: 100] But now yf you wolde represente 100 other any nomber aboue it, you muste do that with the ryghte hande, after this maner. [You must expresse 100 in the ryght hand, with the lytell fynger so bowed as you dyd expresse 1 in the left hand. [Sidenote: 200] [*136b] And as you expressed 2 in the lefte hande, the same fasshyon in the ryght hande doth declare 200. [Sidenote: 300] The fourme of 3 in the ryght hand standeth for 300. [Sidenote: 400] The fourme of 4, for 400. [Sidenote: 500] Lykewayes the fourme of 5, for 500. [Sidenote: 600] The fourme of 6, for 600. And to be shorte: loke how you did expresse single vnities and tenthes in the lefte hande, so must you expresse vnities {and} tenthes of hundredes, in the ryghte hande. [Sidenote: 900] _S._ I vnderstande you thus: that yf I wold represent 900, I must so fourme the fyngers of my ryghte hande, as I shuld do in my left hand to expresse 9, [Sidenote: 1000] And as in my lefte hand I expressed 10, so in my ryght hande must I expresse 1000. And so the fourme of euery tenthe in the lefte hande serueth to expresse lyke no{m}ber of thousa{n}des, [Sidenote: 4000] so y^e fourme of 40 standeth for 4000. [Sidenote: 8000] The fourme of 80 for 8000. [Sidenote: 9000] [*137a] And the fourme of 90 (whiche is the greatest) for 9000, and aboue that I can not expresse any nomber. _M._ No not with one fynger: how be it, w{i}t{h} dyuers fyngers you maye expresse 9999, and all at one tyme, and that lac keth but 1 of 10000. So that vnder 10000 you may by your fyngers ex- presse any summe. And this shal suf- fyce for Numeration on the fyngers. And as for Addition, Subtraction, Multiplicatio{n}, and Diuision (which yet were neuer taught by any man as farre as I do knowe) I wyll enstruct you after the treatyse of fractions. And now for this tyme fare well, and loke that you cease not to practyse that you haue lear ned. _S._ Syr, with moste harty mynde I thanke you, bothe for your good learnyng, {and} also your good cou{ns}el, which (god wyllyng) I truste to folow. Finis. FOOTNOTES (Accomptynge by counters _and_ The arte of nombrynge by the hande): [1: 1342 in original.] [2: 168 in original.] [3: Bracket ([) denotes new paragraph in original.] APPENDIX I. +A Treatise on the Numeration of Algorism.+ [_From a MS. of the 14th Century._] To alle suche even nombrys the most have cifrys as to ten. twenty. thirtty. an hundred. an thousand and suche other. but ye schal vnderstonde that a cifre tokeneth nothinge but he maketh other the more significatyf that comith after hym. Also ye schal vnderstonde that in nombrys composyt and in alle other nombrys that ben of diverse figurys ye schal begynne in the ritht syde and to rekene backwarde and so he schal be wryte as thus--1000. the sifre in the ritht side was first wryte and yit he tokeneth nothinge to the secunde no the thridde but thei maken that figure of 1 the more signyficatyf that comith after hem by as moche as he born oute of his first place where he schuld yf he stode ther tokene but one. And there he stondith nowe in the ferye place he tokeneth a thousand as by this rewle. In the first place he tokeneth but hymself. In the secunde place he tokeneth ten times hymself. In the thridde place he tokeneth an hundred tymes himself. In the ferye he tokeneth a thousand tymes himself. In the fyftye place he tokeneth ten thousand tymes himself. In the sexte place he tokeneth an hundred thousand tymes hymself. In the seveth place he tokeneth ten hundred thousand tymes hymself, &c. And ye schal vnderstond that this worde nombre is partyd into thre partyes. Somme is callyd nombre of digitys for alle ben digitys that ben withine ten as ix, viii, vii, vi, v, iv, iii, ii, i. Articules ben alle thei that mow be devyded into nombrys of ten as xx, xxx, xl, and suche other. Composittys be alle nombrys that ben componyd of a digyt and of an articule as fourtene fyftene thrittene and suche other. Fourtene is componyd of four that is a digyt and of ten that is an articule. Fyftene is componyd of fyve that is a digyt and of ten that is an articule and so of others . . . . . . But as to this rewle. In the firste place he tokeneth but himself that is to say he tokeneth but that and no more. If that he stonde in the secunde place he tokeneth ten tymes himself as this figure 2 here 21. this is oon and twenty. This figure 2 stondith in the secunde place and therfor he tokeneth ten tymes himself and ten tymes 2 is twenty and so forye of every figure and he stonde after another toward the lest syde he schal tokene ten tymes as moche more as he schuld token and he stode in that place ther that the figure afore him stondeth: lo an example as thus 9634. This figure of foure that hath this schape 4 tokeneth but himself for he stondeth in the first place. The figure of thre that hath this schape 3 tokeneth ten tyme himself for he stondeth in the secunde place and that is thritti. The figure of sexe that hath this schape 6 tokeneth ten tyme more than he schuld and he stode in the place yer the figure of thre stondeth for ther he schuld tokene but sexty. And now he tokeneth ten tymes that is sexe hundrid. The figure of nyne that hath this schape 9 tokeneth ten tymes more than he schulde and he stode in the place ther the figure of 6 stondeth inne for thanne he schuld tokene but nyne hundryd. And in the place that he stondeth inne nowe he tokeneth nine thousand. Alle the hole nombre of these foure figurys. Nine thousand sexe hundrid and foure and thritti. APPENDIX II. Carmen de Algorismo. [_From a B.M. MS., 8 C. iv., with additions from 12 E. 1 & Eg. 2622._] Hec algorismus ars presens dicitur[{1}]; in qua Talibus Indorum[{2}] fruimur his quinque figuris. 0. 9. 8. 7. 6. 5. 4. 3. 2. 1. Prima significat unum: duo vero secunda: Tercia significat tria: sic procede sinistre 4 Donec ad extremam venies, qua cifra vocatur; [{3}][Que nil significat; dat significare sequenti.] Quelibet illarum si primo limite ponas, Simpliciter se significat: si vero secundo, 8 Se decies: sursum procedas multiplicando.[{4}] [Namque figura sequens quevis signat decies plus, Ipsa locata loco quam significet pereunte: 12 Nam precedentes plus ultima significabit.] [{5}]Post predicta scias quod tres breuiter numerorum Distincte species sunt; nam quidam digiti sunt; Articuli quidam; quidam quoque compositi sunt. 16 [Sunt digiti numeri qui citra denarium sunt; Articuli decupli degitorum; compositi sunt Illi qui constant ex articulis digitisque.] Ergo, proposito numero tibi scribere, primo 20 Respicias quis sit numerus; quia si digitus sit, [{5}][Una figura satis sibi; sed si compositus sit,] Primo scribe loco digitum post articulum fac Articulus si sit, cifram post articulum sit, 24 [Articulum vero reliquenti in scribe figure.] Quolibet in numero, si par sit prima figura, Par erit et totum, quicquid sibi continetur; Impar si fuerit, totum sibi fiet et impar. 28 Septem[{6}] sunt partes, non plures, istius artis; Addere, subtrahere, duplare, dimidiare; Sexta est diuidere, set quinta est multiplicare; Radicem extrahere pars septima dicitur esse. 32 Subtrahis aut addis a dextris vel mediabis; A leua dupla, diuide, multiplicaque; Extrahe radicem semper sub parte sinistra. [Sidenote: Addition.] Addere si numero numerum vis, ordine tali 36 Incipe; scribe duas primo series numerorum Prima sub prima recte ponendo figuram, Et sic de reliquis facias, si sint tibi plures. Inde duas adde primas hac condicione; 40 Si digitus crescat ex addicione priorum, Primo scribe loco digitum, quicunque sit ille; Si sit compositus, in limite scribe sequenti Articulum, primo digitum; quia sic iubet ordo. 44 Articulus si sit, in primo limite cifram, Articulum vero reliquis inscribe figuris; Vel per se scribas si nulla figura sequatur. Si tibi cifra superueniens occurrerit, illam 48 Deme suppositam; post illic scribe figuram: Postea procedas reliquas addendo figuras. [Sidenote: Subtraction.] A numero numerum si sit tibi demere cura, Scribe figurarum series, vt in addicione; 52 Maiori numero numerum suppone minorem, Siue pari numero supponatur numerus par. Postea si possis a prima subtrahe primam, Scribens quod remanet, cifram si nil remanebit. 56 Set si non possis a prima demere primam; Procedens, vnum de limite deme sequenti; Et demptum pro denario reputabis ab illo, Subtrahe totaliter numerum quem proposuisti. 60 Quo facto, scribe supra quicquit remanebit, Facque novenarios de cifris, cum remanebis, Occurrant si forte cifre, dum demseris vnum; Postea procedas reliquas demendo figuras. 64 [Sidenote: Proof.] [{7}][Si subtracio sit bene facta probare valebis, Quas subtraxisti primas addendo figuras. Nam, subtractio si bene sit, primas retinebis, Et subtractio facta tibi probat additionem.] 68 [Sidenote: Duplation.] Si vis duplare numerum, sic incipe; solam Scribe figurarum seriem, quamcumque voles que Postea procedas primam duplando figuram; Inde quod excrescet, scribens, vbi iusserit ordo, 72 Juxta precepta que dantur in addicione. Nam si sit digitus, in primo limite scribe; Articulus si sit, in primo limite cifram, Articulum vero reliquis inscribe figuris; 76 Vel per se scribas, si nulla figura sequatur: Compositus si sit, in limite scribe sequenti Articulum primo, digitum; quia sic jubet ordo: Et sic de reliquis facias, si sint tibi plures. 80 [{8}][Si super extremam nota sit, monadem dat eidem, Quod tibi contingit, si primo dimidiabis.] [Sidenote: Mediation.] Incipe sic, si vis aliquem numerum mediare: Scribe figurarum seriem solam, velud ante; 84 Postea procedens medias, et prima figura Si par aut impar videas; quia si fuerit par, Dimidiabis eam, scribens quicquit remanebit; Impar si fuerit, vnum demas, mediare, 88 Nonne presumas, sed quod superest mediabis; Inde super tractum, fac demptum quod notat unum; Si monos, dele; sit ibi cifra post nota supra. Postea procedas hac condicione secunda:[{9}] 92 Impar[{10}] si fuerit hic vnum deme priori, Inscribens quinque, nam denos significabit Monos prędictam: si vero secunda dat vnam, Illa deleta, scribatur cifra; priori 96 Tradendo quinque pro denario mediato; Nec cifra scribatur, nisi inde figura sequatur: Postea procedas reliquas mediando figuras, Quin supra docui, si sint tibi mille figure. 100 [{11}][Si mediatio sit bene facta probare valebis, Duplando numerum quem primo dimidiasti.] Si super extremam nota sit monades dat eidem Quod contingat cum primo dimiabis Atque figura prior nuper fuerit mediando.] [Sidenote: Multiplication.] Si tu per numerum numerum vis multiplicare, Scribe duas, quascunque volis, series numerorum; 104 Ordo tamen seruetur vt vltima multiplicandi Ponatur super anteriorem multiplicantis; [{12}][A leua relique sint scripte multiplicantes.] In digitum cures digitum si ducere, major 108 Per quantes distat a denis respice, debes Namque suo decuplo tociens delere minorem; Sicque tibi numerus veniens exinde patebit. Postea procedas postremam multiplicando, 112 Juste multiplicans per cunctas inferiores, Condicione tamen tali; quod multiplicantis Scribas in capite, quicquid processerit inde; Set postquam fuerit hec multiplicata, figure 116 Anteriorentur seriei multiplicantis; Et sic multiplica, velut istam multiplicasti, Qui sequitur numerum scriptum quicunque figuris. Set cum multiplicas, primo sic est operandum, 120 Si dabit articulum tibi multiplicacio solum; Proposita cifra, summam transferre memento. Sin autem digitus excrescerit articulusque, Articulus supraposito digito salit ultra; 124 Si digitus tamen, ponas illum super ipsam, Subdita multiplicans hanc que super incidit illi Delet eam penitus, scribens quod provenit inde; Sed si multiplices illam posite super ipsam, 128 Adiungens numerum quem prebet ductus earum; Si supraimpositam cifra debet multiplicare, Prorsus eam delet, scribi que loco cifra debet, [{12}][Si cifra multiplicat aliam positam super ipsam, 132 Sitque locus supra vacuus super hanc cifra fiet;] Si supra fuerit cifra semper pretereunda est; Si dubites, an sit bene multiplicando secunda, Diuide totalem numerum per multiplicantem, 136 Et reddet numerus emergens inde priorem. [Sidenote: Mental Multiplication.] [{13}][Per numerum si vis numerum quoque multiplicare Tantum per normas subtiles absque figuris Has normas poteris per versus scire sequentes. 140 Si tu per digitum digitum quilibet multiplicabis Regula precedens dat qualiter est operandum Articulum si per reliquum vis multiplicare In proprium digitum debebit uterque resolvi 144 Articulus digitos post per se multiplicantes Ex digitis quociens teneret multiplicatum Articuli faciunt tot centum multiplicati. Articulum digito si multiplicamus oportet 148 Articulum digitum sumi quo multiplicare Debemus reliquum quod multiplicaris ab illis Per reliquo decuplum sic omne latere nequibit In numerum mixtum digitum si ducere cures 152 Articulus mixti sumatur deinde resolvas In digitum post hec fac ita de digitis nec Articulusque docet excrescens in detinendo In digitum mixti post ducas multiplicantem 156 De digitis ut norma docet sit juncta secundo Multiplica summam et postea summa patebit Junctus in articulum purum articulumque [{14}][Articulum purum comittes articulum que] 160 Mixti pro digitis post fiat et articulus vt Norma jubet retinendo quod egreditur ab illis Articuli digitum post in digitum mixti duc Regula de digitis ut percipit articulusque 164 Ex quibus excrescens summe tu junge priori Sic manifesta cito fiet tibi summa petita. Compositum numerum mixto sic multiplicabis Vndecies tredecem sic est ex hiis operandum 168 In reliquum primum demum duc post in eundem Unum post deinde duc in tercia deinde per unum Multiplices tercia demum tunc omnia multiplicata In summa duces quam que fuerit te dices 172 Hic ut hic mixtus intentus est operandum Multiplicandorum de normis sufficiunt hec.] [Sidenote: Division.] Si vis dividere numerum, sic incipe primo; Scribe duas, quascunque voles, series numerorum; 176 Majori numero numerum suppone minorem, [{15}][Nam docet ut major teneat bis terve minorem;] Et sub supprima supprimam pone figuram, Sic reliquis reliquas a dextra parte locabis; 180 Postea de prima primam sub parte sinistra Subtrahe, si possis, quociens potes adminus istud, Scribens quod remanet sub tali conditione; Ut totiens demas demendas a remanente, 184 Que serie recte ponentur in anteriori, Unica si, tantum sit ibi decet operari; Set si non possis a prima demere primam, Procedas, et eam numero suppone sequenti; 188 Hanc uno retrahendo gradu quo comites retrahantur, Et, quotiens poteris, ab eadem deme priorem, Ut totiens demas demendas a remanenti, Nec plus quam novies quicquam tibi demere debes, 192 Nascitur hinc numerus quociens supraque sequentem Hunc primo scribas, retrahas exinde figuras, Dum fuerit major supra positus inferiori, Et rursum fiat divisio more priori; 196 Et numerum quotiens supra scribas pereunti, Si fiat saliens retrahendo, cifra locetur, Et pereat numero quotiens, proponas eidem Cifram, ne numerum pereat vis, dum locus illic 200 Restat, et expletis divisio non valet ultra: Dum fuerit numerus numerorum inferiore seorsum Illum servabis; hinc multiplicando probabis, [Sidenote: Proof.] Si bene fecisti, divisor multiplicetur 204 Per numerum quotiens; cum multiplicaveris, adde Totali summę, quod servatum fuit ante, Reddeturque tibi numerus quem proposuisti; Et si nil remanet, hunc multiplicando reddet, 208 [Sidenote: Square Numbers.] Cum ducis numerum per se, qui provenit inde Sit tibi quadratus, ductus radix erit hujus, Nec numeros omnes quadratos dicere debes, Est autem omnis numerus radix alicujus. 212 Quando voles numeri radicem querere, scribi Debet; inde notes si sit locus ulterius impar, Estque figura loco talis scribenda sub illo, Que, per se dicta, numerum tibi destruat illum, 216 Vel quantum poterit ex inde delebis eandem; Vel retrahendo duples retrahens duplando sub ista Que primo sequitur, duplicatur per duplacationem, Post per se minuens pro posse quod est minuendum. 220 [{16}]Post his propones digitum, qui, more priori Per precedentes, post per se multiplicatus, Destruat in quantum poterit numerum remanentem, Et sic procedens retrahens duplando figuram, 224 Preponendo novam donec totum peragatur, Subdupla propriis servare docetque duplatis; Si det compositum numerum duplacio, debet Inscribi digitus a parte dextra parte propinqua, 228 Articulusque loco quo non duplicata resessit; Si dabit articulum, sit cifra loco pereunte Articulusque locum tenet unum, de duplicata resessit; Si donet digitum, sub prima pone sequente, 232 Si supraposita fuerit duplicata figura Major proponi debet tantummodo cifra, Has retrahens solito propones more figuram, Usque sub extrema ita fac retrahendo figuras, 236 Si totum deles numerum quem proposuisti, Quadratus fuerit, de dupla quod duplicasti, Sicque tibi radix illius certa patebit, Si de duplatis fit juncta supprima figura; 240 Radicem per se multiplices habeasque Primo propositum, bene te fecisse probasti; Non est quadratus, si quis restat, sed habentur Radix quadrati qui stat major sub eadem; 244 Vel quicquid remanet tabula servare memento; Hoc casu radix per se quoque multiplicetur, Vel sic quadratus sub primo major habetur, Hinc addas remanens, et prius debes haberi; 248 Si locus extremus fuerit par, scribe figuram Sub pereunte loco per quam debes operari, Que quantum poterit supprimas destruat ambas, Vel penitus legem teneas operando priorem, 252 Si suppositum digitus suo fine repertus, Omnino delet illic scribi cifra debet, A leva si qua sit ei sociata figura; Si cifre remanent in fine pares decet harum 256 Radices, numero mediam proponere partem, Tali quesita radix patet arte reperta. Per numerum recte si nosti multiplicare Ejus quadratum, numerus qui pervenit inde 260 Dicetur cubicus; primus radix erit ejus; Nec numeros omnes cubicatos dicere debes, Est autem omnis numerus radix alicujus; [Sidenote: Cube Root.] Si curas cubici radicem quęrere, primo 264 Inscriptum numerum distinguere per loca debes; Que tibi mille notant a mille notante suprema Initiam, summa operandi parte sinistra, Illic sub scribas digitum, qui multiplicatus 268 In semet cubice suprapositum sibi perdat, Et si quid fuerit adjunctum parte sinistra Si non omnino, quantum poteris minuendo, Hinc triplans retrahe saltum, faciendo sub illa 272 Que manet a digito deleto terna, figuram Illi propones quo sub triplo asocietur, Ut cum subtriplo per eam tripla multiplicatur; Hinc per eam solam productum multiplicabis, 276 Postea totalem numerum, qui provenit inde A suprapositis respectu tolle triplate Addita supprimo cubice tunc multiplicetur, Respectu cujus, numerus qui progredietur 280 Ex cubito ductu, supra omnes adimetur; Tunc ipsam delens triples saltum faciendo, Semper sub ternas, retrahens alias triplicatas Ex hinc triplatis aliam propone figuram, 284 Que per triplatas ducatur more priori; Primo sub triplis sibi junctis, postea per se, In numerum ducta, productum de triplicatis: Utque prius dixi numerus qui provenit inde 288 A suprapositis has respiciendo trahatur, Huic cubice ductum sub primo multiplicabis, Respectumque sui, removebis de remanenti, Et sic procedas retrahendo triplando figuram. 292 Et proponendo nonam, donec totum peragatur, Subtripla sub propriis servare decet triplicatis; Si nil in fine remanet, numerus datus ante Est cubicus; cubicam radicem sub tripla prebent, 296 Cum digito juncto quem supprimo posuisti, Hec cubice ducta, numerum reddant tibi primum. Si quid erit remanens non est cubicus, sed habetur Major sub primo qui stat radix cubicam, 300 Servari debet quicquid radice remansit, Extracto numero, decet hec addi cubicato. Quo facto, numerus reddi debet tibi primus. Nam debes per se radicem multiplicare 304 Ex hinc in numerum duces, qui provenit inde Sub primo cubicus major sic invenietur; Illi jungatur remanens, et primus habetur, Si per triplatum numerum nequeas operari; 308 Cifram propones, nil vero per hanc operare Set retrahens illam cum saltu deinde triplata, Propones illi digitum sub lege priori, Cumque cifram retrahas saliendo, non triplicabis, 312 Namque nihil cifre triplacio dicitur esse; At tu cum cifram protraxeris aut triplicata, Hanc cum subtriplo semper servare memento: Si det compositum, digiti triplacio debet 316 Illius scribi, digitus saliendo sub ipsam; Digito deleto, que terna dicitur esse; Jungitur articulus cum triplata pereunte, Set facit hunc scribi per se triplacio prima, 320 Que si det digitum per se scribi facit illum; Consumpto numero, si sole fuit tibi cifre Triplato, propone cifram saltum faciendo, Cumque cifram retrahe triplam, scribendo figuram, 324 Preponas cifre, sic procedens operare, Si tres vel duo serie in sint, pone sub yma, A dextris digitum servando prius documentum. Si sit continua progressio terminus nuper 328 Per majus medium totalem multiplicato; Si par, per medium tunc multiplicato sequentem. Set si continua non sit progressio finis: Impar, tunc majus medium si multiplicabis, 332 Si par per medium sibi multiplicato propinquum. 333 FOOTNOTES (Appendix II, Carmen de Algorismo): [1: "Hec pręsens ars dicitur algorismus ab Algore rege ejus inventore, vel dicitur ab _algos_ quod est ars, et _rodos_ quod est numerus; quę est ars numerorum vel numerandi, ad quam artem bene sciendum inveniebantur apud Indos bis quinque (id est decem) figurę." --_Comment. Thomę de Novo-Mercatu._ MS. Bib. Reg. Mus. Brit. 12 E. 1.] [2: "Hę necessarię figurę sunt Indorum characteros." _MS. de numeratione._ Bib. Sloan. Mus. Brit. 513, fol. 58. "Cum vidissem Yndos constituisse IX literas in universo numero suo propter dispositionem suam quam posuerunt, volui patefacere de opere quod sit per eas aliquidque esset levius discentibus, si Deus voluerit. Si autem Indi hoc voluerunt et intentio illorum nihil novem literis fuit, causa que mihi potuit. Deus direxit me ad hoc. Si vero alia dicam preter eam quam ego exposui, hoc fecerunt per hoc quod ego exposui, eadem tam certissime et absque ulla dubitatione poterit inveniri. Levitasque patebit aspicientibus et discentibus." MS. U.L.C., Ii. vi. 5, f. 102.] [3: From Eg. 2622.] [4: 8 C. iv. inserts Nullum cipa significat: dat significare sequenti.] [5: From 12 E. 1.] [6: En argorisme devon prendre Vii especes . . . . Adision subtracion Doubloison mediacion Monteploie et division Et de radix eustracion A chez vii especes savoir Doit chascun en memoire avoir Letres qui figures sont dites Et qui excellens sont ecrites. --MS. _Seld. Arch._ B. 26.] [7: From 12 E. 1.] [8: From 12 E. 1.] [9: 8 C. iv. inserts Atque figura prior nuper fuerit mediando.] [10: _I.e._ figura secundo loco posita.] [11: So 12 E. 1; 8 C. iv. inserts-- [12: 12 E. 1 inserts.] [13: 12 E. 1 inserts to l. 174.] [14: 12 E. 1 omits, Eg. 2622 inserts.] [15: 12 E. 1 inserts.] [16: 8 C. iv. inserts-- Hinc illam dele duplans sub ei psalliendo Que sequitur retrahens quicquid fuerit duplicatum.] INDEX OF TECHNICAL TERMS[1*] [Footnote 1*: This Index has been kindly prepared by Professor J. B. Dale, of King's College, University of London, and the best thanks of the Society are due to him for his valuable contribution.] [Transcriber's Note: The Technical Terms and Glossary (following) refer to page and line numbers in the printed book. Information in [[double brackets]] has been added by the transcriber to aid in text searching.] +algorisme+, 33/12; +algorym+, +augrym+, 3/3; the art of computing, using the so-called Arabic numerals. The word in its various forms is derived from the Arabic _al-Khowarazmi_ (i.e. the native of Khwarazm (Khiva)). This was the surname of Ja'far Mohammad ben Musa, who wrote a treatise early in the 9th century (see p. xiv). The form _algorithm_ is also found, being suggested by a supposed derivation from the Greek +arithmos+ (number). +antery+, 24/11; to move figures to the right of the position in which they are first written. This operation is performed repeatedly upon the multiplier in multiplication, and upon certain figures which arise in the process of root extraction. +anterioracioun+, 50/5; the operation of moving figures to the right. [[written anteriorac{i}o{u}n or anterioracio{u}n]] +article+, 34/23; +articul+, 5/31; +articuls+, 9/36, 29/7,8; a number divisible by ten without remainder. [[also articull{e}]] +cast+, 8/12; to add one number to another. 'Addition is a _casting_ together of two numbers into one number,' 8/10. +cifre+, 4/1; the name of the figure 0. The word is derived from the Arabic _sifr_ = empty, nothing. Hence _zero_. A cipher is the symbol of the absence of number or of zero quantity. It may be used alone or in conjunction with digits or other ciphers, and in the latter case, according to the position which it occupies relative to the other figures, indicates the absence of units, or tens, or hundreds, etc. The great superiority of the Arabic to all other systems of notation resides in the employment of this symbol. When the cipher is not used, the place value of digits has to be indicated by writing them in assigned rows or columns. Ciphers, however, may be interpolated amongst the significant figures used, and as they sufficiently indicate the positions of the empty rows or columns, the latter need not be indicated in any other way. The practical performance of calculations is thus enormously facilitated (see p. xvi). +componede+, 33/24; +composyt+, 5/35; with reference to numbers, one compounded of a multiple of ten and a digit. [[written componed{e}]] +conuertide+ = conversely, 46/29, 47/9. [[written co{n}u{er}tid{e} or {con}u{er}tid{e}]] +cubicede+, 50/13; +to be c.+, to have its cube root found. [[written cubiced{e}]] +cubike nombre+, 47/8; a number formed by multiplying a given number twice by itself, _e.g._ 27 = 3 × 3 × 3. Now called simply a cube. [[written cubik{e} ...]] +decuple+, 22/12; the product of a number by ten. Tenfold. +departys+ = divides, 5/29. [[written dep{ar}tys]] +digit+, 5/30; +digitalle+, 33/24; a number less than ten, represented by one of the nine Arabic numerals. [[written digitall{e}]] +dimydicion+, 7/23; the operation of dividing a number by two. Halving. [[written dimydicioń]] +duccioun+, multiplication, 43/9. [[written duccio{u}n]] +duplacion+, 7/23, 14/15; the operation of multiplying a number by two. Doubling. [[written duplacioń or duplacio[n~] with fancy "n"]] +i-mediet+ = halved, 19/23. +intercise+ = broken, 46/2; intercise Progression is the name given to either of the Progressions 1, 3, 5, 7, etc.; 2, 4, 6, 8, etc., in which the common difference is 2. [[written int{er}cise]] +lede into+, multiply by, 47/18. [[words always separated, as "lede ... into"]] +lyneal nombre+, 46/14; a number such as that which expresses the measure of the length of a line, and therefore is not _necessarily_ the product of two or more numbers (_vide_ Superficial, Solid). This appears to be the meaning of the phrase as used in _The Art of Nombryng_. It is possible that the numbers so designated are the prime numbers, that is, numbers not divisible by any other number except themselves and unity, but it is not clear that this limitation is intended. +mediacioun+, 16/36, 38/16; dividing by two (see also +dimydicion+). [[written mediacio[n~] with fancy "n", generally without "u"]] +medlede nombre+, 34/1; a number formed of a multiple of ten and a digit (_vide_ componede, composyt). [[written medled{e} ...]] +medye+, 17/8, to halve; +mediete+, halved, 17/30; +ymedit+, 20/9. +naturelle progressioun+, 45/22; the series of numbers 1, 2, 3, etc. [[written naturell{e} p{ro}gressio{u}n]] +produccioun+, multiplication, 50/11. [[written produccio{u}n]] +quadrat nombre+, 46/12; a number formed by multiplying a given number by itself, _e.g._ 9 = 3 × 3, a square. +rote+, 7/25; +roote+, 47/11; root. The roots of squares and cubes are the numbers from which the squares and cubes are derived by multiplication into themselves. +significatyf+, significant, 5/14; The significant figures of a number are, strictly speaking, those other than zero, _e.g._ in 3 6 5 0 4 0 0, the significant figures are 3, 6, 5, 4. Modern usage, however, regards all figures between the two extreme significant figures as significant, even when some are zero. Thus, in the above example, 3 6 5 0 4 are considered significant. +solide nombre+, 46/37; a number which is the product of three other numbers, _e.g._ 66 = 11 × 2 × 3. [[usually written solid{e}]] +superficial nombre+, 46/18; a number which is the product of two other numbers, _e.g._ 6 = 2 × 3. [[written sup{er}ficial or sup{er}ficiall{e}]] +ternary+, consisting of three digits, 51/7. [[written t{er}nary]] +vnder double+, a digit which has been doubled, 48/3. +vnder-trebille+, a digit which has been trebled, 49/28; +vnder-triplat+, 49/39. [[written vnder-trebill{e}, vnder-t{r}iplat]] +w+, a symbol used to denote half a unit, 17/33 [[printed as superscript ^w]] GLOSSARY [Transcriber's Note: Words whose first appearance is earlier than the page cited in the Glossary are identified in double-bracketed notes. To aid in text searching, words written with internal {italics} are also noted, and context is given for common words.] +ablacioun+, taking away, 36/21 [[written ablacio{u}n]] +addyst+, haddest, 10/37 +agregacioun+, addition, 45/22. (First example in N.E.D., 1547.) [[written ag{r}egacio{u}n]] +a-[gh]enenes+, against, 23/10 +allgate+, always, 8/39 +als+, as, 22/24 +and+, if, 29/8; +&+, 4/27; +& yf+, 20/7 +a-nendes+, towards, 23/15 +aproprede+, appropriated, 34/27 [[written ap{ro}pred{e}]] +apwereth+, appears, 61/8 +a-risy[gh]t+, arises, 14/24 +a-rowe+, in a row, 29/10 +arsemetrike+, arithmetic, 33/1 [[written arsemetrik{e}]] +ayene+, again, 45/15 +bagle+, crozier, 67/12 +bordure+ = ordure, row, 43/30 [[written bordur{e}]] +borro+, _inf._ borrow, 11/38; _imp. s._ +borowe+, 12/20; _pp._ +borwed+, 12/15; +borred+, 12/19 +boue+, above, 42/34 +caputule+, chapter, 7/26 [[written caputul{e}]] +certayn+, assuredly, 18/34 [[written c{er}tay[n~]]] +clepede+, called, 47/7 [[written cleped{e}]] +competently+, conveniently, 35/8 +compt+, count, 47/29 +contynes+, contains, 21/12; [[written {con}tynes]] _pp._ +contenythe+, 38/39 [[written co{n}tenyth{e}]] +craft+, art, 3/4 +distingue+, divide, 51/5 +egalle+, equal, 45/21 [[written egall{e}]] +excep+, except, 5/16] +exclusede+, excluded, 34/37 [[written exclused{e}]] +excressent+, resulting, 35/16 [[written exc{re}ssent]] +exeant+, resulting, 43/26 +expone+, expound, 3/23 +ferye+ = ferže, fourth, 70/12 +figure+ = figures, 5/1 [[written fig{ure}]] +for-by+, past, 12/11 +fors; no f.+, no matter, 22/24 +forseth+, matters, 53/30 +forye+ = forže, forth, 71/8] +fyftye+ = fyftže, fifth, 70/16 +grewe+, Greek, 33/13 +haluendel+, half, 16/16; +haldel+, 19/4; _pl._ +haluedels+, 16/16 +hayst+, hast, 17/3, 32 +hast+, haste, 22/25 [[in "haue hast to"]] +heer+, higher, 9/35 +here+, their, 7/26 [[in "in her{e} caputul{e}"]] +here-a-fore+, heretofore, 13/7 [[written her{e}-a-for{e}]] +heyth+, was called, 3/5 +hole+, whole, 4/39; +holle+, 17/1; +hoole+, of three dimensions, 46/15 +holdyže+, holds good, 30/5 +how be it that+, although, 44/4 +lede+ = lete, let, 8/37 +lene+, lend, 12/39 +lest+, least, 43/27 [[in "at the lest"]] +lest+ = left, 71/9 [[in "the lest syde"]] +leue+, leave, 6/5; _pr. 3 s._ +leues+, remains, 11/19; [[first in 10/40]] +leus+, 11/28; _pp._ +laft+, left, 19/24 +lewder+, more ignorant, 3/3 [[written lewd{er}]] +lust+, desirest to, 45/13 +ly[gh]t+, easy, 15/31 +lymytes+, limits, 34/18; +lynes+, 34/12; +lynees+, 34/17; Lat. limes, _pl._ limites. +maystery+, achievement; [[written mayst{er}y]] +no m.+, no achievement, i.e. easy, 19/10 +me+, _indef. pron._ one, 42/1 [[first in 34/16]] +mo+, more, 9/16 +moder+ = more (Lat. majorem), 43/22 +most+, must, 30/3 [[first in 3/12 and many more]] +multipliede+, +to be m.+ = multiplying, 40/9 +mynvtes+, the sixty parts into which a unit is divided, 38/25 [[written mynvt{es}]] +myse-wro[gh]t+, mis-wrought, 14/11 +nether+, nor, 34/25 [[in "It was, nether is"]] +nex+, next, 19/9 +no[gh]t+, nought, 5/7 [[first in 4/8]] +note+, not, 30/5 +oo+, one, 42/20; +o+, 42/21 [[first in 34/27; 33/22]] +omest+, uppermost, higher, 35/26; +omyst+, 35/28 +omwhile+, sometimes, 45/31 [[first in 39/17]] +on+, one, 8/29 [[in "on vnder an-ož{er}"]] +opyne+, plain, 47/8 [[written opyn{e}]] +or+, before, 13/25 [[in "or žou be-gan"]] +or+ = že ož{er}, the other, 28/34 [[in "or by-twene"]] +ordure+, order, 34/9; row, 43/1 [[word form is "order"]] +other+, or, 33/13, 43/26; [[in "art other craft" on 33/13, "other how oft" on 43/26; note also "one other other" on 35/24]] +other . . . or+, either . . . or, 38/37 [[in "other it is even or od{e}" on 38/37; there are earlier occurrences]] +ouerer+, upper, 42/15 [[written ou{er}er]] +ouer-hippede+, passed over, 43/19 [[written ou{er}-hipped{e}]] +recte+, directly, 27/20 [[in "stondes not recte"; also on 26/31 in "recte ou{er} his hede"]] +remayner+, remainder, 56/28 +representithe+, represented, 39/14 [[written rep{re}sentith{e}]] +resteth+, remains, 63/29 [[first in 57/29 and others]] +rewarde+, regard, 48/6 [[written reward{e}]] +rew+, row, 4/8 +rewle+, row, 4/20, 7/12; [[in "place of že rewle", "že rewle of fig{ure}s"]] +rewele+, 4/18; +rewles+, rules, 5/33 +s.+ = scilicet, 3/8 [[in "s. Algorism{us}"]] +sentens+, meaning, 14/29 +signifye(tyf)+, 5/13. The last three letters are added above the line, evidently because of the word 'significatyf' in l. 14. But the 'Solucio,' which contained the word, has been omitted. +sithen+, since, 33/8 +some+, sum, result, 40/17, 32 [[first in 36/21 in "me may see a some", then in "the same some" and "to some of"]] +sowne+, pronounce, 6/29 +singillatim+, singly, 7/25 +spices+, species, kinds, 34/4 [[first in 5/34 and others]] +spyl+, waste, 14/26 +styde+, stead, 18/20 +subtrahe+, subtract, 48/12; _pp._ +subtrayd+, 13/21 +sythes+, times, 21/16 +ta[gh]t+, taught, 16/36 +take+, _pp._ taken; +t. fro+, starting from, 45/22 [[in "fro oone or tweyn{e} take"]] +taward+, toward, 23/34 +thou[gh]t+, though, 5/20 +trebille+, multiply by three, 49/26 [[written trebill{e}]] +twene+, two, 8/11 [[first in 4/23]] +žow+, though, 25/15 [[in "žow ž{o}u take"]] +žow[gh]t+, thought; +be ž.+, mentally, 28/4 +žus+ = žis, this, 20/33 [[in "žus nombur 214"]] +vny+, unite, 45/10 +wel+, wilt, 14/31 [[in "If ž{o}u wel"]] +wete+, wit, 15/16; +wyte+, know, 8/38; _pr. 2 s._ +wost+, 12/38 +wex+, become, 50/18 +where+, whether, 29/12 [[written wher{e} in "wher{e} in že secunde, or"]] +wher-thurghe+, whence, 49/15 [[written Wher-thurgh{e}]] +worch+, work, 8/19; [[first in 7/35]] +wrich+, 8/35; +wyrch+, 6/19; _imp. s._ +worch+, 15/9; [[first in 9/6]] _pp._ +y-wroth+, 13/24 +write+, written, 29/19; [[first in 6/37 in "hast write", "be write"]] +y-write+, 16/1 +wryrchynge+ = wyrchynge, working, 30/4 [[written wryrchyng{e}]] +w^t+, with, 55/8 +y-broth+, brought, 21/18 +ychon+, each one, 29/10 [[written ycho[n~]]] +ydo+, done, added, 9/6 [[first in 8/37 in "haue ydo"; 9/6 in "ydo all to-ged{er}"]] +ylke+, same, 5/12 +y-lyech+, alike, 22/23 +y-my[gh]t+, been able, 12/2 +y-now[gh]t+, enough, 15/31; +ynov[gh]t+, 18/34 +yove+, given, 45/33 +y^t+, that, 52/8 +y-write+, _v._ +write.+ +y-wroth+, _v._ +worch.+ * * * * * * * * * * * * * * MARGINAL NOTES: +Headnotes+ have been moved to the beginning of the appropriate paragraph. Headnotes were omitted from the two Appendixes, as sidenotes give the same information. +Line Numbers+ are cited in the Index and Glossary. They have been omitted from the e-text except in the one verse selection (App. II, _Carmen de Algorismo_). Instead, the Index and Glossary include supplemental information to help locate each word. +Numbered Notes+: Numbered sidenotes show page or leaf numbers from the original MSS. In the e-text, the page number is shown as [*123b] inline; mid-word page breaks are marked with a supplemental asterisk [*]. Numbers are not used. Footnotes give textual information such as variant readings. They have been numbered sequentially within each title, with numbers shown as [{1}] to avoid confusion with bracked text--including single numerals--in the original. Editorial notes are shown as [1*]. When a footnote calls for added text, the addition is shown in the body text with [[double brackets]]. +Sidenotes+ giving a running synopsis of the text have been moved to the beginning of each paragraph, where they are shown as a single note. ERRORS AND ANOMALIES (Noted by Transcriber): Introduction: dated Mij^c [_In this and the remainder of the paragraph, the letter shown as ^c is printed directly above the preceding j._] The Crafte of Nombrynge: sursu{m} {pr}ocedas m{u}ltiplicando [_Italicized as shown: error for "p{ro}cedas"?_] Sidenote: Our author makes a slip here [_Elsewhere in the book, numerical errors are corrected in the body text, with a footnote giving the original form._] ten tymes so mych is že nounb{re} [_text unchanged: error for "as"?_] 6 tymes 24, [{19}]žen take [_misplaced footnote anchor in original: belongs with "6 times 24"_] Fn. 7: 'Subt{ra}has a{u}t addis a dext{ri}s [_open quote missing_] The Art of Nombryng: oone of the digitis as .10. of 1.. 20. of. 2. [_text unchanged: error for "as .10. of .1. 20. of .2."?_] sette a-side half of tho m{inutes} [_text unchanged: error for "the"?_] and. 10. as before is come therof [_text unchanged: error for "and .10."?_] Sidenote: Where to set the quotiente [_spelling (1922) unchanged_] Sidenote: Definition of Progression. [_f in "of" illegible_] Sidenote: ... giving the value of ab.^2 [_That is, "a(b^2)."_] Accomptynge by counters: For example of the [*117a.] ly[*]nes [_final . in sidenote missing or invisible_] [_also in 121b, 122a] which in the fyrst summe is 5 [_invisible "5" supplied by transcriber_] [*116a (_sic_).] [_Editor's "sic": page numbering jumps back to 116 instead of the expected 123, and continues from 116._] [*123a] ... set downe y^e multiplyer .v. tymes, as here you se [_Diagram shown as printed, with 35500 for 36500 in one column, and apparent misplaced "thousands" marker_] 365 (which is the nomber of dayes ... [_open ( missing_] The arte of nombrynge by the hande: for 1 the fynger is clasped in [_In at least one printing of the text, "clasped" is misprinted as "elasped"_] but this teacyed me not [_text unchanged_] Appendix I: A Treatise on the Numeration of Algorism: _See Introduction and Glossary for long s:f and ž:y errors_ Appendix II: Carmen de Algorismo: _In this selection, errors that are not explained in footnotes were assumed to be typographic._ l. 99 Postea procedas [procdeas] l. 163 Articuli digitum post in digitum mixti duc [post iu] End of Project Gutenberg's The Earliest Arithmetics in English, by Anonymous *** END OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK THE EARLIEST ARiTHMETICS IN ENGLISH *** ***** This file should be named 25664-8.txt or 25664-8.zip ***** This and all associated files of various formats will be found in: http://www.gutenberg.org/2/5/6/6/25664/ Produced by Louise Hope, David Starner and the Online Distributed Proofreading Team at http://www.pgdp.net Updated editions will replace the previous one--the old editions will be renamed. Creating the works from public domain print editions means that no one owns a United States copyright in these works, so the Foundation (and you!) can copy and distribute it in the United States without permission and without paying copyright royalties. Special rules, set forth in the General Terms of Use part of this license, apply to copying and distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works to protect the PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm concept and trademark. Project Gutenberg is a registered trademark, and may not be used if you charge for the eBooks, unless you receive specific permission. If you do not charge anything for copies of this eBook, complying with the rules is very easy. You may use this eBook for nearly any purpose such as creation of derivative works, reports, performances and research. They may be modified and printed and given away--you may do practically ANYTHING with public domain eBooks. Redistribution is subject to the trademark license, especially commercial redistribution. *** START: FULL LICENSE *** THE FULL PROJECT GUTENBERG LICENSE PLEASE READ THIS BEFORE YOU DISTRIBUTE OR USE THIS WORK To protect the Project Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting the free distribution of electronic works, by using or distributing this work (or any other work associated in any way with the phrase "Project Gutenberg"), you agree to comply with all the terms of the Full Project Gutenberg-tm License (available with this file or online at http://gutenberg.org/license). Section 1. General Terms of Use and Redistributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works 1.A. By reading or using any part of this Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work, you indicate that you have read, understand, agree to and accept all the terms of this license and intellectual property (trademark/copyright) agreement. If you do not agree to abide by all the terms of this agreement, you must cease using and return or destroy all copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in your possession. If you paid a fee for obtaining a copy of or access to a Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work and you do not agree to be bound by the terms of this agreement, you may obtain a refund from the person or entity to whom you paid the fee as set forth in paragraph 1.E.8. 1.B. "Project Gutenberg" is a registered trademark. It may only be used on or associated in any way with an electronic work by people who agree to be bound by the terms of this agreement. There are a few things that you can do with most Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works even without complying with the full terms of this agreement. See paragraph 1.C below. There are a lot of things you can do with Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works if you follow the terms of this agreement and help preserve free future access to Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works. See paragraph 1.E below. 1.C. The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation ("the Foundation" or PGLAF), owns a compilation copyright in the collection of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works. Nearly all the individual works in the collection are in the public domain in the United States. If an individual work is in the public domain in the United States and you are located in the United States, we do not claim a right to prevent you from copying, distributing, performing, displaying or creating derivative works based on the work as long as all references to Project Gutenberg are removed. Of course, we hope that you will support the Project Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting free access to electronic works by freely sharing Project Gutenberg-tm works in compliance with the terms of this agreement for keeping the Project Gutenberg-tm name associated with the work. You can easily comply with the terms of this agreement by keeping this work in the same format with its attached full Project Gutenberg-tm License when you share it without charge with others. 1.D. The copyright laws of the place where you are located also govern what you can do with this work. Copyright laws in most countries are in a constant state of change. If you are outside the United States, check the laws of your country in addition to the terms of this agreement before downloading, copying, displaying, performing, distributing or creating derivative works based on this work or any other Project Gutenberg-tm work. The Foundation makes no representations concerning the copyright status of any work in any country outside the United States. 1.E. Unless you have removed all references to Project Gutenberg: 1.E.1. The following sentence, with active links to, or other immediate access to, the full Project Gutenberg-tm License must appear prominently whenever any copy of a Project Gutenberg-tm work (any work on which the phrase "Project Gutenberg" appears, or with which the phrase "Project Gutenberg" is associated) is accessed, displayed, performed, viewed, copied or distributed: This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org 1.E.2. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is derived from the public domain (does not contain a notice indicating that it is posted with permission of the copyright holder), the work can be copied and distributed to anyone in the United States without paying any fees or charges. If you are redistributing or providing access to a work with the phrase "Project Gutenberg" associated with or appearing on the work, you must comply either with the requirements of paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 or obtain permission for the use of the work and the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark as set forth in paragraphs 1.E.8 or 1.E.9. 1.E.3. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is posted with the permission of the copyright holder, your use and distribution must comply with both paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 and any additional terms imposed by the copyright holder. Additional terms will be linked to the Project Gutenberg-tm License for all works posted with the permission of the copyright holder found at the beginning of this work. 1.E.4. Do not unlink or detach or remove the full Project Gutenberg-tm License terms from this work, or any files containing a part of this work or any other work associated with Project Gutenberg-tm. 1.E.5. Do not copy, display, perform, distribute or redistribute this electronic work, or any part of this electronic work, without prominently displaying the sentence set forth in paragraph 1.E.1 with active links or immediate access to the full terms of the Project Gutenberg-tm License. 1.E.6. You may convert to and distribute this work in any binary, compressed, marked up, nonproprietary or proprietary form, including any word processing or hypertext form. However, if you provide access to or distribute copies of a Project Gutenberg-tm work in a format other than "Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other format used in the official version posted on the official Project Gutenberg-tm web site (www.gutenberg.org), you must, at no additional cost, fee or expense to the user, provide a copy, a means of exporting a copy, or a means of obtaining a copy upon request, of the work in its original "Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other form. Any alternate format must include the full Project Gutenberg-tm License as specified in paragraph 1.E.1. 1.E.7. Do not charge a fee for access to, viewing, displaying, performing, copying or distributing any Project Gutenberg-tm works unless you comply with paragraph 1.E.8 or 1.E.9. 1.E.8. You may charge a reasonable fee for copies of or providing access to or distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works provided that - You pay a royalty fee of 20% of the gross profits you derive from the use of Project Gutenberg-tm works calculated using the method you already use to calculate your applicable taxes. The fee is owed to the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark, but he has agreed to donate royalties under this paragraph to the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation. Royalty payments must be paid within 60 days following each date on which you prepare (or are legally required to prepare) your periodic tax returns. Royalty payments should be clearly marked as such and sent to the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation at the address specified in Section 4, "Information about donations to the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation." - You provide a full refund of any money paid by a user who notifies you in writing (or by e-mail) within 30 days of receipt that s/he does not agree to the terms of the full Project Gutenberg-tm License. You must require such a user to return or destroy all copies of the works possessed in a physical medium and discontinue all use of and all access to other copies of Project Gutenberg-tm works. - You provide, in accordance with paragraph 1.F.3, a full refund of any money paid for a work or a replacement copy, if a defect in the electronic work is discovered and reported to you within 90 days of receipt of the work. - You comply with all other terms of this agreement for free distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm works. 1.E.9. If you wish to charge a fee or distribute a Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work or group of works on different terms than are set forth in this agreement, you must obtain permission in writing from both the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation and Michael Hart, the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark. Contact the Foundation as set forth in Section 3 below. 1.F. 1.F.1. Project Gutenberg volunteers and employees expend considerable effort to identify, do copyright research on, transcribe and proofread public domain works in creating the Project Gutenberg-tm collection. Despite these efforts, Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works, and the medium on which they may be stored, may contain "Defects," such as, but not limited to, incomplete, inaccurate or corrupt data, transcription errors, a copyright or other intellectual property infringement, a defective or damaged disk or other medium, a computer virus, or computer codes that damage or cannot be read by your equipment. 1.F.2. LIMITED WARRANTY, DISCLAIMER OF DAMAGES - Except for the "Right of Replacement or Refund" described in paragraph 1.F.3, the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation, the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark, and any other party distributing a Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work under this agreement, disclaim all liability to you for damages, costs and expenses, including legal fees. YOU AGREE THAT YOU HAVE NO REMEDIES FOR NEGLIGENCE, STRICT LIABILITY, BREACH OF WARRANTY OR BREACH OF CONTRACT EXCEPT THOSE PROVIDED IN PARAGRAPH F3. YOU AGREE THAT THE FOUNDATION, THE TRADEMARK OWNER, AND ANY DISTRIBUTOR UNDER THIS AGREEMENT WILL NOT BE LIABLE TO YOU FOR ACTUAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE OR INCIDENTAL DAMAGES EVEN IF YOU GIVE NOTICE OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. 1.F.3. LIMITED RIGHT OF REPLACEMENT OR REFUND - If you discover a defect in this electronic work within 90 days of receiving it, you can receive a refund of the money (if any) you paid for it by sending a written explanation to the person you received the work from. If you received the work on a physical medium, you must return the medium with your written explanation. The person or entity that provided you with the defective work may elect to provide a replacement copy in lieu of a refund. If you received the work electronically, the person or entity providing it to you may choose to give you a second opportunity to receive the work electronically in lieu of a refund. If the second copy is also defective, you may demand a refund in writing without further opportunities to fix the problem. 1.F.4. Except for the limited right of replacement or refund set forth in paragraph 1.F.3, this work is provided to you 'AS-IS' WITH NO OTHER WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTIBILITY OR FITNESS FOR ANY PURPOSE. 1.F.5. Some states do not allow disclaimers of certain implied warranties or the exclusion or limitation of certain types of damages. If any disclaimer or limitation set forth in this agreement violates the law of the state applicable to this agreement, the agreement shall be interpreted to make the maximum disclaimer or limitation permitted by the applicable state law. The invalidity or unenforceability of any provision of this agreement shall not void the remaining provisions. 1.F.6. INDEMNITY - You agree to indemnify and hold the Foundation, the trademark owner, any agent or employee of the Foundation, anyone providing copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in accordance with this agreement, and any volunteers associated with the production, promotion and distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works, harmless from all liability, costs and expenses, including legal fees, that arise directly or indirectly from any of the following which you do or cause to occur: (a) distribution of this or any Project Gutenberg-tm work, (b) alteration, modification, or additions or deletions to any Project Gutenberg-tm work, and (c) any Defect you cause. Section 2. Information about the Mission of Project Gutenberg-tm Project Gutenberg-tm is synonymous with the free distribution of electronic works in formats readable by the widest variety of computers including obsolete, old, middle-aged and new computers. It exists because of the efforts of hundreds of volunteers and donations from people in all walks of life. Volunteers and financial support to provide volunteers with the assistance they need, is critical to reaching Project Gutenberg-tm's goals and ensuring that the Project Gutenberg-tm collection will remain freely available for generations to come. In 2001, the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation was created to provide a secure and permanent future for Project Gutenberg-tm and future generations. To learn more about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation and how your efforts and donations can help, see Sections 3 and 4 and the Foundation web page at http://www.pglaf.org. Section 3. Information about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation is a non profit 501(c)(3) educational corporation organized under the laws of the state of Mississippi and granted tax exempt status by the Internal Revenue Service. The Foundation's EIN or federal tax identification number is 64-6221541. Its 501(c)(3) letter is posted at http://pglaf.org/fundraising. Contributions to the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation are tax deductible to the full extent permitted by U.S. federal laws and your state's laws. The Foundation's principal office is located at 4557 Melan Dr. S. Fairbanks, AK, 99712., but its volunteers and employees are scattered throughout numerous locations. Its business office is located at 809 North 1500 West, Salt Lake City, UT 84116, (801) 596-1887, email business@pglaf.org. Email contact links and up to date contact information can be found at the Foundation's web site and official page at http://pglaf.org For additional contact information: Dr. Gregory B. Newby Chief Executive and Director gbnewby@pglaf.org Section 4. Information about Donations to the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation Project Gutenberg-tm depends upon and cannot survive without wide spread public support and donations to carry out its mission of increasing the number of public domain and licensed works that can be freely distributed in machine readable form accessible by the widest array of equipment including outdated equipment. Many small donations ($1 to $5,000) are particularly important to maintaining tax exempt status with the IRS. The Foundation is committed to complying with the laws regulating charities and charitable donations in all 50 states of the United States. Compliance requirements are not uniform and it takes a considerable effort, much paperwork and many fees to meet and keep up with these requirements. We do not solicit donations in locations where we have not received written confirmation of compliance. To SEND DONATIONS or determine the status of compliance for any particular state visit http://pglaf.org While we cannot and do not solicit contributions from states where we have not met the solicitation requirements, we know of no prohibition against accepting unsolicited donations from donors in such states who approach us with offers to donate. International donations are gratefully accepted, but we cannot make any statements concerning tax treatment of donations received from outside the United States. U.S. laws alone swamp our small staff. Please check the Project Gutenberg Web pages for current donation methods and addresses. Donations are accepted in a number of other ways including checks, online payments and credit card donations. To donate, please visit: http://pglaf.org/donate Section 5. General Information About Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works. Professor Michael S. Hart is the originator of the Project Gutenberg-tm concept of a library of electronic works that could be freely shared with anyone. For thirty years, he produced and distributed Project Gutenberg-tm eBooks with only a loose network of volunteer support. Project Gutenberg-tm eBooks are often created from several printed editions, all of which are confirmed as Public Domain in the U.S. unless a copyright notice is included. Thus, we do not necessarily keep eBooks in compliance with any particular paper edition. Most people start at our Web site which has the main PG search facility: http://www.gutenberg.org This Web site includes information about Project Gutenberg-tm, including how to make donations to the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation, how to help produce our new eBooks, and how to subscribe to our email newsletter to hear about new eBooks.